* gcc.dg/vect/slp-perm-1.c (main): Make sure loops aren't vectorized.
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / expr.c
blob3e5d18bdebc7639d6622b3f1567ed3b0d628e3d5
1 /* Convert tree expression to rtl instructions, for GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1988, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
3 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6 This file is part of GCC.
8 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
9 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
10 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
11 version.
13 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
14 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
15 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
16 for more details.
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
20 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
22 #include "config.h"
23 #include "system.h"
24 #include "coretypes.h"
25 #include "tm.h"
26 #include "machmode.h"
27 #include "rtl.h"
28 #include "tree.h"
29 #include "flags.h"
30 #include "regs.h"
31 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
32 #include "except.h"
33 #include "function.h"
34 #include "insn-config.h"
35 #include "insn-attr.h"
36 /* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
37 #include "expr.h"
38 #include "optabs.h"
39 #include "libfuncs.h"
40 #include "recog.h"
41 #include "reload.h"
42 #include "output.h"
43 #include "typeclass.h"
44 #include "toplev.h"
45 #include "langhooks.h"
46 #include "intl.h"
47 #include "tm_p.h"
48 #include "tree-iterator.h"
49 #include "tree-pass.h"
50 #include "tree-flow.h"
51 #include "target.h"
52 #include "timevar.h"
53 #include "df.h"
54 #include "diagnostic.h"
55 #include "ssaexpand.h"
56 #include "target-globals.h"
58 /* Decide whether a function's arguments should be processed
59 from first to last or from last to first.
61 They should if the stack and args grow in opposite directions, but
62 only if we have push insns. */
64 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
66 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
67 #if defined (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD) != defined (ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD)
68 #define PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED /* If it's last to first. */
69 #endif
70 #endif
72 #endif
74 #ifndef STACK_PUSH_CODE
75 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
76 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_DEC
77 #else
78 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_INC
79 #endif
80 #endif
83 /* If this is nonzero, we do not bother generating VOLATILE
84 around volatile memory references, and we are willing to
85 output indirect addresses. If cse is to follow, we reject
86 indirect addresses so a useful potential cse is generated;
87 if it is used only once, instruction combination will produce
88 the same indirect address eventually. */
89 int cse_not_expected;
91 /* This structure is used by move_by_pieces to describe the move to
92 be performed. */
93 struct move_by_pieces_d
95 rtx to;
96 rtx to_addr;
97 int autinc_to;
98 int explicit_inc_to;
99 rtx from;
100 rtx from_addr;
101 int autinc_from;
102 int explicit_inc_from;
103 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
104 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
105 int reverse;
108 /* This structure is used by store_by_pieces to describe the clear to
109 be performed. */
111 struct store_by_pieces_d
113 rtx to;
114 rtx to_addr;
115 int autinc_to;
116 int explicit_inc_to;
117 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
118 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
119 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
120 void *constfundata;
121 int reverse;
124 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
125 unsigned int,
126 unsigned int);
127 static void move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
128 struct move_by_pieces_d *);
129 static bool block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void);
130 static bool emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
131 static tree emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int);
132 static void emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
133 static rtx clear_by_pieces_1 (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
134 static void clear_by_pieces (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
135 static void store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces_d *, unsigned int);
136 static void store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
137 struct store_by_pieces_d *);
138 static tree clear_storage_libcall_fn (int);
139 static rtx compress_float_constant (rtx, rtx);
140 static rtx get_subtarget (rtx);
141 static void store_constructor_field (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
142 HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode,
143 tree, tree, int, alias_set_type);
144 static void store_constructor (tree, rtx, int, HOST_WIDE_INT);
145 static rtx store_field (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode,
146 tree, tree, alias_set_type, bool);
148 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree, const_tree);
150 static int is_aligning_offset (const_tree, const_tree);
151 static void expand_operands (tree, tree, rtx, rtx*, rtx*,
152 enum expand_modifier);
153 static rtx reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx, rtx, tree);
154 static rtx do_store_flag (sepops, rtx, enum machine_mode);
155 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
156 static void emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode, rtx, tree);
157 #endif
158 static void do_tablejump (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx);
159 static rtx const_vector_from_tree (tree);
160 static void write_complex_part (rtx, rtx, bool);
162 /* This macro is used to determine whether move_by_pieces should be called
163 to perform a structure copy. */
164 #ifndef MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
165 #define MOVE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
166 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
167 < (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
168 #endif
170 /* This macro is used to determine whether clear_by_pieces should be
171 called to clear storage. */
172 #ifndef CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P
173 #define CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
174 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
175 < (unsigned int) CLEAR_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
176 #endif
178 /* This macro is used to determine whether store_by_pieces should be
179 called to "memset" storage with byte values other than zero. */
180 #ifndef SET_BY_PIECES_P
181 #define SET_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
182 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
183 < (unsigned int) SET_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
184 #endif
186 /* This macro is used to determine whether store_by_pieces should be
187 called to "memcpy" storage when the source is a constant string. */
188 #ifndef STORE_BY_PIECES_P
189 #define STORE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
190 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
191 < (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
192 #endif
194 /* SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS is nonzero if unaligned accesses are very slow. */
196 #ifndef SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
197 #define SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS(MODE, ALIGN) STRICT_ALIGNMENT
198 #endif
200 /* This is run to set up which modes can be used
201 directly in memory and to initialize the block move optab. It is run
202 at the beginning of compilation and when the target is reinitialized. */
204 void
205 init_expr_target (void)
207 rtx insn, pat;
208 enum machine_mode mode;
209 int num_clobbers;
210 rtx mem, mem1;
211 rtx reg;
213 /* Try indexing by frame ptr and try by stack ptr.
214 It is known that on the Convex the stack ptr isn't a valid index.
215 With luck, one or the other is valid on any machine. */
216 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
217 mem1 = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, frame_pointer_rtx);
219 /* A scratch register we can modify in-place below to avoid
220 useless RTL allocations. */
221 reg = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, -1);
223 insn = rtx_alloc (INSN);
224 pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
225 PATTERN (insn) = pat;
227 for (mode = VOIDmode; (int) mode < NUM_MACHINE_MODES;
228 mode = (enum machine_mode) ((int) mode + 1))
230 int regno;
232 direct_load[(int) mode] = direct_store[(int) mode] = 0;
233 PUT_MODE (mem, mode);
234 PUT_MODE (mem1, mode);
235 PUT_MODE (reg, mode);
237 /* See if there is some register that can be used in this mode and
238 directly loaded or stored from memory. */
240 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
241 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
242 && (direct_load[(int) mode] == 0 || direct_store[(int) mode] == 0);
243 regno++)
245 if (! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, mode))
246 continue;
248 SET_REGNO (reg, regno);
250 SET_SRC (pat) = mem;
251 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
252 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
253 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
255 SET_SRC (pat) = mem1;
256 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
257 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
258 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
260 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
261 SET_DEST (pat) = mem;
262 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
263 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
265 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
266 SET_DEST (pat) = mem1;
267 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
268 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
272 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_raw_REG (Pmode, 10000));
274 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); mode != VOIDmode;
275 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
277 enum machine_mode srcmode;
278 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); srcmode != mode;
279 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
281 enum insn_code ic;
283 ic = can_extend_p (mode, srcmode, 0);
284 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
285 continue;
287 PUT_MODE (mem, srcmode);
289 if ((*insn_data[ic].operand[1].predicate) (mem, srcmode))
290 float_extend_from_mem[mode][srcmode] = true;
295 /* This is run at the start of compiling a function. */
297 void
298 init_expr (void)
300 memset (&crtl->expr, 0, sizeof (crtl->expr));
303 /* Copy data from FROM to TO, where the machine modes are not the same.
304 Both modes may be integer, or both may be floating, or both may be
305 fixed-point.
306 UNSIGNEDP should be nonzero if FROM is an unsigned type.
307 This causes zero-extension instead of sign-extension. */
309 void
310 convert_move (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
312 enum machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to);
313 enum machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE (from);
314 int to_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode);
315 int from_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode);
316 enum insn_code code;
317 rtx libcall;
319 /* rtx code for making an equivalent value. */
320 enum rtx_code equiv_code = (unsignedp < 0 ? UNKNOWN
321 : (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND));
324 gcc_assert (to_real == from_real);
325 gcc_assert (to_mode != BLKmode);
326 gcc_assert (from_mode != BLKmode);
328 /* If the source and destination are already the same, then there's
329 nothing to do. */
330 if (to == from)
331 return;
333 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
334 the required extension, strip it. We don't handle such SUBREGs as
335 TO here. */
337 if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from)
338 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (from)))
339 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
340 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (from) == unsignedp)
341 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, from), from_mode = to_mode;
343 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (to) != SUBREG || !SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to));
345 if (to_mode == from_mode
346 || (from_mode == VOIDmode && CONSTANT_P (from)))
348 emit_move_insn (to, from);
349 return;
352 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (from_mode))
354 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode));
356 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode))
357 from = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, from, GET_MODE (from), 0);
358 else
359 to = simplify_gen_subreg (from_mode, to, GET_MODE (to), 0);
361 emit_move_insn (to, from);
362 return;
365 if (GET_CODE (to) == CONCAT && GET_CODE (from) == CONCAT)
367 convert_move (XEXP (to, 0), XEXP (from, 0), unsignedp);
368 convert_move (XEXP (to, 1), XEXP (from, 1), unsignedp);
369 return;
372 if (to_real)
374 rtx value, insns;
375 convert_optab tab;
377 gcc_assert ((GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode)
378 != GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
379 || (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode)
380 != DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode)));
382 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) == GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
383 /* Conversion between decimal float and binary float, same size. */
384 tab = DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode) ? trunc_optab : sext_optab;
385 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
386 tab = sext_optab;
387 else
388 tab = trunc_optab;
390 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
392 code = convert_optab_handler (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
393 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
395 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from,
396 tab == sext_optab ? FLOAT_EXTEND : FLOAT_TRUNCATE);
397 return;
400 /* Otherwise use a libcall. */
401 libcall = convert_optab_libfunc (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
403 /* Is this conversion implemented yet? */
404 gcc_assert (libcall);
406 start_sequence ();
407 value = emit_library_call_value (libcall, NULL_RTX, LCT_CONST, to_mode,
408 1, from, from_mode);
409 insns = get_insns ();
410 end_sequence ();
411 emit_libcall_block (insns, to, value,
412 tab == trunc_optab ? gen_rtx_FLOAT_TRUNCATE (to_mode,
413 from)
414 : gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (to_mode, from));
415 return;
418 /* Handle pointer conversion. */ /* SPEE 900220. */
419 /* Targets are expected to provide conversion insns between PxImode and
420 xImode for all MODE_PARTIAL_INT modes they use, but no others. */
421 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
423 enum machine_mode full_mode
424 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode), MODE_INT);
426 gcc_assert (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode)
427 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
429 if (full_mode != from_mode)
430 from = convert_to_mode (full_mode, from, unsignedp);
431 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode),
432 to, from, UNKNOWN);
433 return;
435 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
437 rtx new_from;
438 enum machine_mode full_mode
439 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode), MODE_INT);
441 gcc_assert (convert_optab_handler (sext_optab, full_mode, from_mode)
442 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
444 if (to_mode == full_mode)
446 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (sext_optab, full_mode,
447 from_mode),
448 to, from, UNKNOWN);
449 return;
452 new_from = gen_reg_rtx (full_mode);
453 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (sext_optab, full_mode, from_mode),
454 new_from, from, UNKNOWN);
456 /* else proceed to integer conversions below. */
457 from_mode = full_mode;
458 from = new_from;
461 /* Make sure both are fixed-point modes or both are not. */
462 gcc_assert (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode) ==
463 ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (to_mode));
464 if (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode))
466 /* If we widen from_mode to to_mode and they are in the same class,
467 we won't saturate the result.
468 Otherwise, always saturate the result to play safe. */
469 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode)
470 && GET_MODE_SIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
471 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 0);
472 else
473 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 1);
474 return;
477 /* Now both modes are integers. */
479 /* Handle expanding beyond a word. */
480 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)
481 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
483 rtx insns;
484 rtx lowpart;
485 rtx fill_value;
486 rtx lowfrom;
487 int i;
488 enum machine_mode lowpart_mode;
489 int nwords = CEIL (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode), UNITS_PER_WORD);
491 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
492 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
493 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
495 /* If FROM is a SUBREG, put it into a register. Do this
496 so that we always generate the same set of insns for
497 better cse'ing; if an intermediate assignment occurred,
498 we won't be doing the operation directly on the SUBREG. */
499 if (optimize > 0 && GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG)
500 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
501 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
502 return;
504 /* Next, try converting via full word. */
505 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD
506 && ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, word_mode, unsignedp))
507 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
509 rtx word_to = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
510 if (REG_P (to))
512 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
513 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
514 emit_clobber (to);
516 convert_move (word_to, from, unsignedp);
517 emit_unop_insn (code, to, word_to, equiv_code);
518 return;
521 /* No special multiword conversion insn; do it by hand. */
522 start_sequence ();
524 /* Since we will turn this into a no conflict block, we must ensure
525 that the source does not overlap the target. */
527 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
528 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
530 /* Get a copy of FROM widened to a word, if necessary. */
531 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
532 lowpart_mode = word_mode;
533 else
534 lowpart_mode = from_mode;
536 lowfrom = convert_to_mode (lowpart_mode, from, unsignedp);
538 lowpart = gen_lowpart (lowpart_mode, to);
539 emit_move_insn (lowpart, lowfrom);
541 /* Compute the value to put in each remaining word. */
542 if (unsignedp)
543 fill_value = const0_rtx;
544 else
545 fill_value = emit_store_flag (gen_reg_rtx (word_mode),
546 LT, lowfrom, const0_rtx,
547 VOIDmode, 0, -1);
549 /* Fill the remaining words. */
550 for (i = GET_MODE_SIZE (lowpart_mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD; i < nwords; i++)
552 int index = (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? nwords - i - 1 : i);
553 rtx subword = operand_subword (to, index, 1, to_mode);
555 gcc_assert (subword);
557 if (fill_value != subword)
558 emit_move_insn (subword, fill_value);
561 insns = get_insns ();
562 end_sequence ();
564 emit_insn (insns);
565 return;
568 /* Truncating multi-word to a word or less. */
569 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD
570 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
572 if (!((MEM_P (from)
573 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
574 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
575 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
576 || REG_P (from)
577 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
578 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
579 convert_move (to, gen_lowpart (word_mode, from), 0);
580 return;
583 /* Now follow all the conversions between integers
584 no more than a word long. */
586 /* For truncation, usually we can just refer to FROM in a narrower mode. */
587 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)
588 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
589 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)))
591 if (!((MEM_P (from)
592 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
593 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
594 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
595 || REG_P (from)
596 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
597 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
598 if (REG_P (from) && REGNO (from) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
599 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (from), to_mode))
600 from = copy_to_reg (from);
601 emit_move_insn (to, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
602 return;
605 /* Handle extension. */
606 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode))
608 /* Convert directly if that works. */
609 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
610 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
612 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
613 return;
615 else
617 enum machine_mode intermediate;
618 rtx tmp;
619 tree shift_amount;
621 /* Search for a mode to convert via. */
622 for (intermediate = from_mode; intermediate != VOIDmode;
623 intermediate = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (intermediate))
624 if (((can_extend_p (to_mode, intermediate, unsignedp)
625 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
626 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (intermediate)
627 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
628 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (intermediate))))
629 && (can_extend_p (intermediate, from_mode, unsignedp)
630 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
632 convert_move (to, convert_to_mode (intermediate, from,
633 unsignedp), unsignedp);
634 return;
637 /* No suitable intermediate mode.
638 Generate what we need with shifts. */
639 shift_amount = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
640 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)
641 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode));
642 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, force_reg (from_mode, from));
643 tmp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, from, shift_amount,
644 to, unsignedp);
645 tmp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, tmp, shift_amount,
646 to, unsignedp);
647 if (tmp != to)
648 emit_move_insn (to, tmp);
649 return;
653 /* Support special truncate insns for certain modes. */
654 if (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode,
655 from_mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
657 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, from_mode),
658 to, from, UNKNOWN);
659 return;
662 /* Handle truncation of volatile memrefs, and so on;
663 the things that couldn't be truncated directly,
664 and for which there was no special instruction.
666 ??? Code above formerly short-circuited this, for most integer
667 mode pairs, with a force_reg in from_mode followed by a recursive
668 call to this routine. Appears always to have been wrong. */
669 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode))
671 rtx temp = force_reg (to_mode, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
672 emit_move_insn (to, temp);
673 return;
676 /* Mode combination is not recognized. */
677 gcc_unreachable ();
680 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
681 from converting X to mode MODE.
682 Both X and MODE may be floating, or both integer.
683 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
684 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
685 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion. */
688 convert_to_mode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
690 return convert_modes (mode, VOIDmode, x, unsignedp);
693 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
694 from converting X from mode OLDMODE to mode MODE.
695 Both modes may be floating, or both integer.
696 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
698 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
699 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
701 You can give VOIDmode for OLDMODE, if you are sure X has a nonvoid mode. */
704 convert_modes (enum machine_mode mode, enum machine_mode oldmode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
706 rtx temp;
708 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
709 the required extension, strip it. */
711 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
712 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))) >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
713 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (x) == unsignedp)
714 x = gen_lowpart (mode, x);
716 if (GET_MODE (x) != VOIDmode)
717 oldmode = GET_MODE (x);
719 if (mode == oldmode)
720 return x;
722 /* There is one case that we must handle specially: If we are converting
723 a CONST_INT into a mode whose size is twice HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT and
724 we are to interpret the constant as unsigned, gen_lowpart will do
725 the wrong if the constant appears negative. What we want to do is
726 make the high-order word of the constant zero, not all ones. */
728 if (unsignedp && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
729 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
730 && CONST_INT_P (x) && INTVAL (x) < 0)
732 double_int val = uhwi_to_double_int (INTVAL (x));
734 /* We need to zero extend VAL. */
735 if (oldmode != VOIDmode)
736 val = double_int_zext (val, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode));
738 return immed_double_int_const (val, mode);
741 /* We can do this with a gen_lowpart if both desired and current modes
742 are integer, and this is either a constant integer, a register, or a
743 non-volatile MEM. Except for the constant case where MODE is no
744 wider than HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, we must be narrowing the operand. */
746 if ((CONST_INT_P (x)
747 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
748 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
749 && GET_MODE_CLASS (oldmode) == MODE_INT
750 && (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE
751 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (oldmode)
752 && ((MEM_P (x) && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (x)
753 && direct_load[(int) mode])
754 || (REG_P (x)
755 && (! HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
756 || HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (x), mode))
757 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
758 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))))))))
760 /* ?? If we don't know OLDMODE, we have to assume here that
761 X does not need sign- or zero-extension. This may not be
762 the case, but it's the best we can do. */
763 if (CONST_INT_P (x) && oldmode != VOIDmode
764 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (oldmode))
766 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
767 int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode);
769 /* We must sign or zero-extend in this case. Start by
770 zero-extending, then sign extend if we need to. */
771 val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
772 if (! unsignedp
773 && (val & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1))))
774 val |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << width;
776 return gen_int_mode (val, mode);
779 return gen_lowpart (mode, x);
782 /* Converting from integer constant into mode is always equivalent to an
783 subreg operation. */
784 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode) && GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
786 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode));
787 return simplify_gen_subreg (mode, x, oldmode, 0);
790 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
791 convert_move (temp, x, unsignedp);
792 return temp;
795 /* STORE_MAX_PIECES is the number of bytes at a time that we can
796 store efficiently. Due to internal GCC limitations, this is
797 MOVE_MAX_PIECES limited by the number of bytes GCC can represent
798 for an immediate constant. */
800 #define STORE_MAX_PIECES MIN (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
802 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes can be moved by using several move
803 instructions. Return nonzero if a call to move_by_pieces should
804 succeed. */
807 can_move_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
808 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
810 return MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align);
813 /* Generate several move instructions to copy LEN bytes from block FROM to
814 block TO. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
816 If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
817 used to push FROM to the stack.
819 ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
821 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
822 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
823 stpcpy. */
826 move_by_pieces (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
827 unsigned int align, int endp)
829 struct move_by_pieces_d data;
830 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode, from_addr_mode
831 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from));
832 rtx to_addr, from_addr = XEXP (from, 0);
833 unsigned int max_size = MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
834 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
835 enum insn_code icode;
837 align = MIN (to ? MEM_ALIGN (to) : align, MEM_ALIGN (from));
839 data.offset = 0;
840 data.from_addr = from_addr;
841 if (to)
843 to_addr_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (to));
844 to_addr = XEXP (to, 0);
845 data.to = to;
846 data.autinc_to
847 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
848 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
849 data.reverse
850 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
852 else
854 to_addr_mode = VOIDmode;
855 to_addr = NULL_RTX;
856 data.to = NULL_RTX;
857 data.autinc_to = 1;
858 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
859 data.reverse = 1;
860 #else
861 data.reverse = 0;
862 #endif
864 data.to_addr = to_addr;
865 data.from = from;
866 data.autinc_from
867 = (GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_DEC
868 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_INC
869 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_DEC);
871 data.explicit_inc_from = 0;
872 data.explicit_inc_to = 0;
873 if (data.reverse) data.offset = len;
874 data.len = len;
876 /* If copying requires more than two move insns,
877 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
878 and use post-increment if available. */
879 if (!(data.autinc_from && data.autinc_to)
880 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (len, align, max_size) > 2)
882 /* Find the mode of the largest move... */
883 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
884 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
885 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
886 mode = tmode;
888 if (USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_from)
890 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode,
891 plus_constant (from_addr, len));
892 data.autinc_from = 1;
893 data.explicit_inc_from = -1;
895 if (USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.autinc_from)
897 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode, from_addr);
898 data.autinc_from = 1;
899 data.explicit_inc_from = 1;
901 if (!data.autinc_from && CONSTANT_P (from_addr))
902 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode, from_addr);
903 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
905 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
906 plus_constant (to_addr, len));
907 data.autinc_to = 1;
908 data.explicit_inc_to = -1;
910 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
912 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
913 data.autinc_to = 1;
914 data.explicit_inc_to = 1;
916 if (!data.autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
917 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
920 tmode = mode_for_size (MOVE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
921 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
922 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
923 else
925 enum machine_mode xmode;
927 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
928 tmode != VOIDmode;
929 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
930 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > MOVE_MAX_PIECES
931 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
932 break;
934 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
937 /* First move what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
938 successively smaller modes. */
940 while (max_size > 1)
942 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
943 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
944 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
945 mode = tmode;
947 if (mode == VOIDmode)
948 break;
950 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
951 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
952 move_by_pieces_1 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, &data);
954 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
957 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
958 gcc_assert (!data.len);
960 if (endp)
962 rtx to1;
964 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
965 if (data.autinc_to)
967 if (endp == 2)
969 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
970 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
971 else
972 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
973 plus_constant (data.to_addr,
974 -1));
976 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
977 data.offset);
979 else
981 if (endp == 2)
982 --data.offset;
983 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
985 return to1;
987 else
988 return data.to;
991 /* Return number of insns required to move L bytes by pieces.
992 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
994 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
995 move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l, unsigned int align,
996 unsigned int max_size)
998 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_insns = 0;
999 enum machine_mode tmode;
1001 tmode = mode_for_size (MOVE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
1002 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
1003 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
1004 else
1006 enum machine_mode tmode, xmode;
1008 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
1009 tmode != VOIDmode;
1010 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
1011 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > MOVE_MAX_PIECES
1012 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
1013 break;
1015 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
1018 while (max_size > 1)
1020 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
1021 enum insn_code icode;
1023 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
1024 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
1025 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
1026 mode = tmode;
1028 if (mode == VOIDmode)
1029 break;
1031 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1032 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1033 n_insns += l / GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), l %= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1035 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1038 gcc_assert (!l);
1039 return n_insns;
1042 /* Subroutine of move_by_pieces. Move as many bytes as appropriate
1043 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
1044 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
1046 static void
1047 move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
1048 struct move_by_pieces_d *data)
1050 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1051 rtx to1 = NULL_RTX, from1;
1053 while (data->len >= size)
1055 if (data->reverse)
1056 data->offset -= size;
1058 if (data->to)
1060 if (data->autinc_to)
1061 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
1062 data->offset);
1063 else
1064 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
1067 if (data->autinc_from)
1068 from1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->from, mode, data->from_addr,
1069 data->offset);
1070 else
1071 from1 = adjust_address (data->from, mode, data->offset);
1073 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
1074 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
1075 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1076 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from < 0)
1077 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr,
1078 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1080 if (data->to)
1081 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, from1));
1082 else
1084 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
1085 emit_single_push_insn (mode, from1, NULL);
1086 #else
1087 gcc_unreachable ();
1088 #endif
1091 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
1092 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1093 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from > 0)
1094 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1096 if (! data->reverse)
1097 data->offset += size;
1099 data->len -= size;
1103 /* Emit code to move a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
1104 string-move instructions, with multiple scalar move instructions,
1105 or with a library call.
1107 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's (perhaps inside VOLATILE) with mode BLKmode.
1108 SIZE is an rtx that says how long they are.
1109 ALIGN is the maximum alignment we can assume they have.
1110 METHOD describes what kind of copy this is, and what mechanisms may be used.
1112 Return the address of the new block, if memcpy is called and returns it,
1113 0 otherwise. */
1116 emit_block_move_hints (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
1117 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
1119 bool may_use_call;
1120 rtx retval = 0;
1121 unsigned int align;
1123 gcc_assert (size);
1124 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
1125 && INTVAL (size) == 0)
1126 return 0;
1128 switch (method)
1130 case BLOCK_OP_NORMAL:
1131 case BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL:
1132 may_use_call = true;
1133 break;
1135 case BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM:
1136 may_use_call = block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm ();
1138 /* Make inhibit_defer_pop nonzero around the library call
1139 to force it to pop the arguments right away. */
1140 NO_DEFER_POP;
1141 break;
1143 case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL:
1144 may_use_call = false;
1145 break;
1147 default:
1148 gcc_unreachable ();
1151 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y));
1152 align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
1153 gcc_assert (align >= BITS_PER_UNIT);
1155 /* Make sure we've got BLKmode addresses; store_one_arg can decide that
1156 block copy is more efficient for other large modes, e.g. DCmode. */
1157 x = adjust_address (x, BLKmode, 0);
1158 y = adjust_address (y, BLKmode, 0);
1160 /* Set MEM_SIZE as appropriate for this block copy. The main place this
1161 can be incorrect is coming from __builtin_memcpy. */
1162 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
1164 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
1165 y = shallow_copy_rtx (y);
1166 set_mem_size (x, size);
1167 set_mem_size (y, size);
1170 if (CONST_INT_P (size) && MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
1171 move_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (size), align, 0);
1172 else if (emit_block_move_via_movmem (x, y, size, align,
1173 expected_align, expected_size))
1175 else if (may_use_call
1176 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
1177 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
1178 retval = emit_block_move_via_libcall (x, y, size,
1179 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
1180 else
1181 emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align);
1183 if (method == BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM)
1184 OK_DEFER_POP;
1186 return retval;
1190 emit_block_move (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
1192 return emit_block_move_hints (x, y, size, method, 0, -1);
1195 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Returns true if calling the
1196 block move libcall will not clobber any parameters which may have
1197 already been placed on the stack. */
1199 static bool
1200 block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void)
1202 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1203 tree fn;
1204 #endif
1206 /* If arguments are pushed on the stack, then they're safe. */
1207 if (PUSH_ARGS)
1208 return true;
1210 /* If registers go on the stack anyway, any argument is sure to clobber
1211 an outgoing argument. */
1212 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1213 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1214 /* Avoid set but not used warning if *REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE doesn't
1215 depend on its argument. */
1216 (void) fn;
1217 if (OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE ((!fn ? NULL_TREE : TREE_TYPE (fn)))
1218 && REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fn) != 0)
1219 return false;
1220 #endif
1222 /* If any argument goes in memory, then it might clobber an outgoing
1223 argument. */
1225 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far;
1226 tree fn, arg;
1228 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1229 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far, TREE_TYPE (fn), NULL_RTX, 0, 3);
1231 arg = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fn));
1232 for ( ; arg != void_list_node ; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
1234 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (arg));
1235 rtx tmp = targetm.calls.function_arg (&args_so_far, mode,
1236 NULL_TREE, true);
1237 if (!tmp || !REG_P (tmp))
1238 return false;
1239 if (targetm.calls.arg_partial_bytes (&args_so_far, mode, NULL, 1))
1240 return false;
1241 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (&args_so_far, mode,
1242 NULL_TREE, true);
1245 return true;
1248 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a movmem pattern;
1249 return true if successful. */
1251 static bool
1252 emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, unsigned int align,
1253 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
1255 rtx opalign = GEN_INT (align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1256 int save_volatile_ok = volatile_ok;
1257 enum machine_mode mode;
1259 if (expected_align < align)
1260 expected_align = align;
1262 /* Since this is a move insn, we don't care about volatility. */
1263 volatile_ok = 1;
1265 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
1266 including more than one in the machine description unless
1267 the more limited one has some advantage. */
1269 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
1270 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
1272 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (movmem_optab, mode);
1273 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
1275 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
1276 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
1277 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
1278 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
1279 actual mode mask. */
1280 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
1281 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
1282 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
1283 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD)
1284 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[0].predicate) == 0
1285 || (*pred) (x, BLKmode))
1286 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[1].predicate) == 0
1287 || (*pred) (y, BLKmode))
1288 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[3].predicate) == 0
1289 || (*pred) (opalign, VOIDmode)))
1291 rtx op2;
1292 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
1293 rtx pat;
1295 op2 = convert_to_mode (mode, size, 1);
1296 pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].predicate;
1297 if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (op2, mode))
1298 op2 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op2);
1300 /* ??? When called via emit_block_move_for_call, it'd be
1301 nice if there were some way to inform the backend, so
1302 that it doesn't fail the expansion because it thinks
1303 emitting the libcall would be more efficient. */
1305 if (insn_data[(int) code].n_operands == 4)
1306 pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (x, y, op2, opalign);
1307 else
1308 pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (x, y, op2, opalign,
1309 GEN_INT (expected_align
1310 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
1311 GEN_INT (expected_size));
1312 if (pat)
1314 emit_insn (pat);
1315 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1316 return true;
1318 else
1319 delete_insns_since (last);
1323 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1324 return false;
1327 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a call to memcpy.
1328 Return the return value from memcpy, 0 otherwise. */
1331 emit_block_move_via_libcall (rtx dst, rtx src, rtx size, bool tailcall)
1333 rtx dst_addr, src_addr;
1334 tree call_expr, fn, src_tree, dst_tree, size_tree;
1335 enum machine_mode size_mode;
1336 rtx retval;
1338 /* Emit code to copy the addresses of DST and SRC and SIZE into new
1339 pseudos. We can then place those new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and
1340 use them later. */
1342 dst_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (dst, 0));
1343 src_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (src, 0));
1345 dst_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, dst_addr);
1346 src_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, src_addr);
1348 dst_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, dst_addr);
1349 src_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, src_addr);
1351 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
1353 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
1354 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
1356 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
1357 memcpy in this context. This could be a user call to memcpy and
1358 the user may wish to examine the return value from memcpy. For
1359 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
1360 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
1362 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
1364 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (true);
1365 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, dst_tree, src_tree, size_tree);
1366 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
1368 retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
1370 return retval;
1373 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move_via_libcall. Create the tree node
1374 for the function we use for block copies. The first time FOR_CALL
1375 is true, we call assemble_external. */
1377 static GTY(()) tree block_move_fn;
1379 void
1380 init_block_move_fn (const char *asmspec)
1382 if (!block_move_fn)
1384 tree args, fn;
1386 fn = get_identifier ("memcpy");
1387 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
1388 const_ptr_type_node, sizetype,
1389 NULL_TREE);
1391 fn = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
1392 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
1393 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
1394 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
1395 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
1396 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
1397 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
1399 block_move_fn = fn;
1402 if (asmspec)
1403 set_user_assembler_name (block_move_fn, asmspec);
1406 static tree
1407 emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int for_call)
1409 static bool emitted_extern;
1411 if (!block_move_fn)
1412 init_block_move_fn (NULL);
1414 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
1416 emitted_extern = true;
1417 make_decl_rtl (block_move_fn);
1418 assemble_external (block_move_fn);
1421 return block_move_fn;
1424 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Copy the data via an explicit
1425 loop. This is used only when libcalls are forbidden. */
1426 /* ??? It'd be nice to copy in hunks larger than QImode. */
1428 static void
1429 emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
1430 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1432 rtx cmp_label, top_label, iter, x_addr, y_addr, tmp;
1433 enum machine_mode x_addr_mode
1434 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x));
1435 enum machine_mode y_addr_mode
1436 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y));
1437 enum machine_mode iter_mode;
1439 iter_mode = GET_MODE (size);
1440 if (iter_mode == VOIDmode)
1441 iter_mode = word_mode;
1443 top_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1444 cmp_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1445 iter = gen_reg_rtx (iter_mode);
1447 emit_move_insn (iter, const0_rtx);
1449 x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
1450 y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
1451 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
1453 emit_jump (cmp_label);
1454 emit_label (top_label);
1456 tmp = convert_modes (x_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1457 x_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (x_addr_mode, x_addr, tmp);
1459 if (x_addr_mode != y_addr_mode)
1460 tmp = convert_modes (y_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1461 y_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (y_addr_mode, y_addr, tmp);
1463 x = change_address (x, QImode, x_addr);
1464 y = change_address (y, QImode, y_addr);
1466 emit_move_insn (x, y);
1468 tmp = expand_simple_binop (iter_mode, PLUS, iter, const1_rtx, iter,
1469 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1470 if (tmp != iter)
1471 emit_move_insn (iter, tmp);
1473 emit_label (cmp_label);
1475 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, size, LT, NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
1476 true, top_label);
1479 /* Copy all or part of a value X into registers starting at REGNO.
1480 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1482 void
1483 move_block_to_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs, enum machine_mode mode)
1485 int i;
1486 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1487 rtx pat;
1488 rtx last;
1489 #endif
1491 if (nregs == 0)
1492 return;
1494 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && ! LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
1495 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
1497 /* See if the machine can do this with a load multiple insn. */
1498 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1499 if (HAVE_load_multiple)
1501 last = get_last_insn ();
1502 pat = gen_load_multiple (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno), x,
1503 GEN_INT (nregs));
1504 if (pat)
1506 emit_insn (pat);
1507 return;
1509 else
1510 delete_insns_since (last);
1512 #endif
1514 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1515 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i),
1516 operand_subword_force (x, i, mode));
1519 /* Copy all or part of a BLKmode value X out of registers starting at REGNO.
1520 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1522 void
1523 move_block_from_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs)
1525 int i;
1527 if (nregs == 0)
1528 return;
1530 /* See if the machine can do this with a store multiple insn. */
1531 #ifdef HAVE_store_multiple
1532 if (HAVE_store_multiple)
1534 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
1535 rtx pat = gen_store_multiple (x, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno),
1536 GEN_INT (nregs));
1537 if (pat)
1539 emit_insn (pat);
1540 return;
1542 else
1543 delete_insns_since (last);
1545 #endif
1547 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1549 rtx tem = operand_subword (x, i, 1, BLKmode);
1551 gcc_assert (tem);
1553 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i));
1557 /* Generate a PARALLEL rtx for a new non-consecutive group of registers from
1558 ORIG, where ORIG is a non-consecutive group of registers represented by
1559 a PARALLEL. The clone is identical to the original except in that the
1560 original set of registers is replaced by a new set of pseudo registers.
1561 The new set has the same modes as the original set. */
1564 gen_group_rtx (rtx orig)
1566 int i, length;
1567 rtx *tmps;
1569 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (orig) == PARALLEL);
1571 length = XVECLEN (orig, 0);
1572 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, length);
1574 /* Skip a NULL entry in first slot. */
1575 i = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1;
1577 if (i)
1578 tmps[0] = 0;
1580 for (; i < length; i++)
1582 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 0));
1583 rtx offset = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 1);
1585 tmps[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_reg_rtx (mode), offset);
1588 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (orig), gen_rtvec_v (length, tmps));
1591 /* A subroutine of emit_group_load. Arguments as for emit_group_load,
1592 except that values are placed in TMPS[i], and must later be moved
1593 into corresponding XEXP (XVECEXP (DST, 0, i), 0) element. */
1595 static void
1596 emit_group_load_1 (rtx *tmps, rtx dst, rtx orig_src, tree type, int ssize)
1598 rtx src;
1599 int start, i;
1600 enum machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_src);
1602 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL);
1604 if (m != VOIDmode
1605 && !SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
1606 && !MEM_P (orig_src)
1607 && GET_CODE (orig_src) != CONCAT)
1609 enum machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1610 if (imode == BLKmode)
1611 src = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_src), ssize, 0);
1612 else
1613 src = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
1614 if (imode != BLKmode)
1615 src = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_src), src);
1616 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1617 /* ...and back again. */
1618 if (imode != BLKmode)
1619 src = gen_lowpart (imode, src);
1620 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
1621 return;
1624 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1625 both on the stack and in registers. */
1626 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, 0), 0))
1627 start = 0;
1628 else
1629 start = 1;
1631 /* Process the pieces. */
1632 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1634 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0));
1635 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 1));
1636 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1637 int shift = 0;
1639 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
1640 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
1642 /* Arrange to shift the fragment to where it belongs.
1643 extract_bit_field loads to the lsb of the reg. */
1644 if (
1645 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
1646 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_src), type, i == start)
1647 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
1648 #else
1649 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
1650 #endif
1652 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
1653 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
1654 gcc_assert (bytelen > 0);
1657 /* If we won't be loading directly from memory, protect the real source
1658 from strange tricks we might play; but make sure that the source can
1659 be loaded directly into the destination. */
1660 src = orig_src;
1661 if (!MEM_P (orig_src)
1662 && (!CONSTANT_P (orig_src)
1663 || (GET_MODE (orig_src) != mode
1664 && GET_MODE (orig_src) != VOIDmode)))
1666 if (GET_MODE (orig_src) == VOIDmode)
1667 src = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1668 else
1669 src = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1671 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1674 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
1675 if (MEM_P (src)
1676 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (src))
1677 || MEM_ALIGN (src) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1678 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
1679 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1681 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1682 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], adjust_address (src, mode, bytepos));
1684 else if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode)
1685 && GET_MODE (src) == mode
1686 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1687 /* Let emit_move_complex do the bulk of the work. */
1688 tmps[i] = src;
1689 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONCAT)
1691 unsigned int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1692 unsigned int slen0 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)));
1694 if ((bytepos == 0 && bytelen == slen0)
1695 || (bytepos != 0 && bytepos + bytelen <= slen))
1697 /* The following assumes that the concatenated objects all
1698 have the same size. In this case, a simple calculation
1699 can be used to determine the object and the bit field
1700 to be extracted. */
1701 tmps[i] = XEXP (src, bytepos / slen0);
1702 if (! CONSTANT_P (tmps[i])
1703 && (!REG_P (tmps[i]) || GET_MODE (tmps[i]) != mode))
1704 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (tmps[i], bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1705 (bytepos % slen0) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1706 1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
1708 else
1710 rtx mem;
1712 gcc_assert (!bytepos);
1713 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen, 0);
1714 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1715 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (mem, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1716 0, 1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
1719 /* FIXME: A SIMD parallel will eventually lead to a subreg of a
1720 SIMD register, which is currently broken. While we get GCC
1721 to emit proper RTL for these cases, let's dump to memory. */
1722 else if (VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dst))
1723 && REG_P (src))
1725 int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1726 rtx mem;
1728 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen, 0);
1729 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1730 tmps[i] = adjust_address (mem, mode, (int) bytepos);
1732 else if (CONSTANT_P (src) && GET_MODE (dst) != BLKmode
1733 && XVECLEN (dst, 0) > 1)
1734 tmps[i] = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, src, GET_MODE(dst), bytepos);
1735 else if (CONSTANT_P (src))
1737 HOST_WIDE_INT len = (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen;
1739 if (len == ssize)
1740 tmps[i] = src;
1741 else
1743 rtx first, second;
1745 gcc_assert (2 * len == ssize);
1746 split_double (src, &first, &second);
1747 if (i)
1748 tmps[i] = second;
1749 else
1750 tmps[i] = first;
1753 else if (REG_P (src) && GET_MODE (src) == mode)
1754 tmps[i] = src;
1755 else
1756 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (src, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1757 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1, NULL_RTX,
1758 mode, mode);
1760 if (shift)
1761 tmps[i] = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
1762 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, shift), tmps[i], 0);
1766 /* Emit code to move a block SRC of type TYPE to a block DST,
1767 where DST is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1768 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_SRC in bytes, or -1
1769 if not known. */
1771 void
1772 emit_group_load (rtx dst, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
1774 rtx *tmps;
1775 int i;
1777 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1778 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
1780 /* Copy the extracted pieces into the proper (probable) hard regs. */
1781 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1783 rtx d = XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0);
1784 if (d == NULL)
1785 continue;
1786 emit_move_insn (d, tmps[i]);
1790 /* Similar, but load SRC into new pseudos in a format that looks like
1791 PARALLEL. This can later be fed to emit_group_move to get things
1792 in the right place. */
1795 emit_group_load_into_temps (rtx parallel, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
1797 rtvec vec;
1798 int i;
1800 vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (parallel, 0));
1801 emit_group_load_1 (&RTVEC_ELT (vec, 0), parallel, src, type, ssize);
1803 /* Convert the vector to look just like the original PARALLEL, except
1804 with the computed values. */
1805 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (parallel, 0); i++)
1807 rtx e = XVECEXP (parallel, 0, i);
1808 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
1810 if (d)
1812 d = force_reg (GET_MODE (d), RTVEC_ELT (vec, i));
1813 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), d, XEXP (e, 1));
1815 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
1818 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (parallel), vec);
1821 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to block DST, where SRC and DST are
1822 non-consecutive groups of registers, each represented by a PARALLEL. */
1824 void
1825 emit_group_move (rtx dst, rtx src)
1827 int i;
1829 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL
1830 && GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL
1831 && XVECLEN (src, 0) == XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1833 /* Skip first entry if NULL. */
1834 for (i = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1835 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0),
1836 XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0));
1839 /* Move a group of registers represented by a PARALLEL into pseudos. */
1842 emit_group_move_into_temps (rtx src)
1844 rtvec vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (src, 0));
1845 int i;
1847 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1849 rtx e = XVECEXP (src, 0, i);
1850 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
1852 if (d)
1853 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), copy_to_reg (d), XEXP (e, 1));
1854 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
1857 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (src), vec);
1860 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block ORIG_DST of type TYPE,
1861 where SRC is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1862 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_DST, or -1 if not
1863 known. */
1865 void
1866 emit_group_store (rtx orig_dst, rtx src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int ssize)
1868 rtx *tmps, dst;
1869 int start, finish, i;
1870 enum machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_dst);
1872 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL);
1874 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
1875 && !MEM_P (orig_dst) && GET_CODE (orig_dst) != CONCAT)
1877 enum machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_dst));
1878 if (imode == BLKmode)
1879 dst = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_dst), ssize, 0);
1880 else
1881 dst = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
1882 emit_group_store (dst, src, type, ssize);
1883 if (imode != BLKmode)
1884 dst = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_dst), dst);
1885 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
1886 return;
1889 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1890 both on the stack and in registers. */
1891 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0))
1892 start = 0;
1893 else
1894 start = 1;
1895 finish = XVECLEN (src, 0);
1897 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, finish);
1899 /* Copy the (probable) hard regs into pseudos. */
1900 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
1902 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0);
1903 if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1905 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg));
1906 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], reg);
1908 else
1909 tmps[i] = reg;
1912 /* If we won't be storing directly into memory, protect the real destination
1913 from strange tricks we might play. */
1914 dst = orig_dst;
1915 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL)
1917 rtx temp;
1919 /* We can get a PARALLEL dst if there is a conditional expression in
1920 a return statement. In that case, the dst and src are the same,
1921 so no action is necessary. */
1922 if (rtx_equal_p (dst, src))
1923 return;
1925 /* It is unclear if we can ever reach here, but we may as well handle
1926 it. Allocate a temporary, and split this into a store/load to/from
1927 the temporary. */
1929 temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dst), ssize, 0);
1930 emit_group_store (temp, src, type, ssize);
1931 emit_group_load (dst, temp, type, ssize);
1932 return;
1934 else if (!MEM_P (dst) && GET_CODE (dst) != CONCAT)
1936 enum machine_mode outer = GET_MODE (dst);
1937 enum machine_mode inner;
1938 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos;
1939 bool done = false;
1940 rtx temp;
1942 if (!REG_P (dst) || REGNO (dst) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1943 dst = gen_reg_rtx (outer);
1945 /* Make life a bit easier for combine. */
1946 /* If the first element of the vector is the low part
1947 of the destination mode, use a paradoxical subreg to
1948 initialize the destination. */
1949 if (start < finish)
1951 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[start]);
1952 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
1953 if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, start), 1)) == bytepos)
1955 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[start],
1956 inner, 0);
1957 if (temp)
1959 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
1960 done = true;
1961 start++;
1966 /* If the first element wasn't the low part, try the last. */
1967 if (!done
1968 && start < finish - 1)
1970 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[finish - 1]);
1971 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
1972 if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, finish - 1), 1)) == bytepos)
1974 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[finish - 1],
1975 inner, 0);
1976 if (temp)
1978 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
1979 done = true;
1980 finish--;
1985 /* Otherwise, simply initialize the result to zero. */
1986 if (!done)
1987 emit_move_insn (dst, CONST0_RTX (outer));
1990 /* Process the pieces. */
1991 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
1993 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 1));
1994 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
1995 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1996 unsigned int adj_bytelen = bytelen;
1997 rtx dest = dst;
1999 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
2000 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2001 adj_bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
2003 if (GET_CODE (dst) == CONCAT)
2005 if (bytepos + adj_bytelen
2006 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2007 dest = XEXP (dst, 0);
2008 else if (bytepos >= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2010 bytepos -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)));
2011 dest = XEXP (dst, 1);
2013 else
2015 enum machine_mode dest_mode = GET_MODE (dest);
2016 enum machine_mode tmp_mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
2018 gcc_assert (bytepos == 0 && XVECLEN (src, 0));
2020 if (GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (dest_mode)
2021 >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmp_mode))
2023 dest = assign_stack_temp (dest_mode,
2024 GET_MODE_SIZE (dest_mode),
2026 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest,
2027 tmp_mode,
2028 bytepos),
2029 tmps[i]);
2030 dst = dest;
2032 else
2034 dest = assign_stack_temp (tmp_mode,
2035 GET_MODE_SIZE (tmp_mode),
2037 emit_move_insn (dest, tmps[i]);
2038 dst = adjust_address (dest, dest_mode, bytepos);
2040 break;
2044 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2046 /* store_bit_field always takes its value from the lsb.
2047 Move the fragment to the lsb if it's not already there. */
2048 if (
2049 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
2050 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_dst), type, i == start)
2051 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
2052 #else
2053 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2054 #endif
2057 int shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2058 tmps[i] = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
2059 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, shift),
2060 tmps[i], 0);
2062 bytelen = adj_bytelen;
2065 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
2066 if (MEM_P (dest)
2067 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (dest))
2068 || MEM_ALIGN (dest) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2069 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
2070 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2071 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, mode, bytepos), tmps[i]);
2072 else
2073 store_bit_field (dest, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2074 mode, tmps[i]);
2077 /* Copy from the pseudo into the (probable) hard reg. */
2078 if (orig_dst != dst)
2079 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
2082 /* Generate code to copy a BLKmode object of TYPE out of a
2083 set of registers starting with SRCREG into TGTBLK. If TGTBLK
2084 is null, a stack temporary is created. TGTBLK is returned.
2086 The purpose of this routine is to handle functions that return
2087 BLKmode structures in registers. Some machines (the PA for example)
2088 want to return all small structures in registers regardless of the
2089 structure's alignment. */
2092 copy_blkmode_from_reg (rtx tgtblk, rtx srcreg, tree type)
2094 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
2095 rtx src = NULL, dst = NULL;
2096 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (type), BITS_PER_WORD);
2097 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0;
2098 enum machine_mode copy_mode;
2100 if (tgtblk == 0)
2102 tgtblk = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type,
2103 (TYPE_QUALS (type)
2104 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST)),
2105 0, 1, 1);
2106 preserve_temp_slots (tgtblk);
2109 /* This code assumes srcreg is at least a full word. If it isn't, copy it
2110 into a new pseudo which is a full word. */
2112 if (GET_MODE (srcreg) != BLKmode
2113 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (srcreg)) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
2114 srcreg = convert_to_mode (word_mode, srcreg, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
2116 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see whether
2117 SRCREG is padded on the left or on the right. If it's on the left,
2118 set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of bits to skip.
2120 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
2121 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
2122 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
2123 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
2124 end of the register. */
2125 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
2126 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (type)
2127 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2128 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
2129 padding_correction
2130 = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD) * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2132 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. If the target lives in
2133 memory, take care of not reading/writing past its end by selecting
2134 a copy mode suited to BITSIZE. This should always be possible given
2135 how it is computed.
2137 We could probably emit more efficient code for machines which do not use
2138 strict alignment, but it doesn't seem worth the effort at the current
2139 time. */
2141 copy_mode = word_mode;
2142 if (MEM_P (tgtblk))
2144 enum machine_mode mem_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
2145 if (mem_mode != BLKmode)
2146 copy_mode = mem_mode;
2149 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
2150 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2151 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2153 /* We need a new source operand each time xbitpos is on a
2154 word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
2155 (the first time through). */
2156 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
2157 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
2158 src = operand_subword_force (srcreg, xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD,
2159 GET_MODE (srcreg));
2161 /* We need a new destination operand each time bitpos is on
2162 a word boundary. */
2163 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2164 dst = operand_subword (tgtblk, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, 1, BLKmode);
2166 /* Use xbitpos for the source extraction (right justified) and
2167 bitpos for the destination store (left justified). */
2168 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, copy_mode,
2169 extract_bit_field (src, bitsize,
2170 xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1,
2171 NULL_RTX, copy_mode, copy_mode));
2174 return tgtblk;
2177 /* Add a USE expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
2178 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
2180 void
2181 use_reg (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg)
2183 gcc_assert (REG_P (reg) && REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2185 *call_fusage
2186 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
2187 gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
2190 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each of NREGS consecutive regs,
2191 starting at REGNO. All of these registers must be hard registers. */
2193 void
2194 use_regs (rtx *call_fusage, int regno, int nregs)
2196 int i;
2198 gcc_assert (regno + nregs <= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2200 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2201 use_reg (call_fusage, regno_reg_rtx[regno + i]);
2204 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each REG contained in the
2205 PARALLEL REGS. This is for calls that pass values in multiple
2206 non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
2208 void
2209 use_group_regs (rtx *call_fusage, rtx regs)
2211 int i;
2213 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); i++)
2215 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i), 0);
2217 /* A NULL entry means the parameter goes both on the stack and in
2218 registers. This can also be a MEM for targets that pass values
2219 partially on the stack and partially in registers. */
2220 if (reg != 0 && REG_P (reg))
2221 use_reg (call_fusage, reg);
2225 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
2226 assigment and the code of the expresion on the RHS is CODE. Return
2227 NULL otherwise. */
2229 static gimple
2230 get_def_for_expr (tree name, enum tree_code code)
2232 gimple def_stmt;
2234 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
2235 return NULL;
2237 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
2238 if (!def_stmt
2239 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) != code)
2240 return NULL;
2242 return def_stmt;
2246 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes generated by CONSTFUN can be
2247 stored to memory using several move instructions. CONSTFUNDATA is
2248 a pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2249 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
2250 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
2251 Return nonzero if a call to store_by_pieces should succeed. */
2254 can_store_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2255 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
2256 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp)
2258 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l;
2259 unsigned int max_size;
2260 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
2261 enum machine_mode mode, tmode;
2262 enum insn_code icode;
2263 int reverse;
2264 rtx cst;
2266 if (len == 0)
2267 return 1;
2269 if (! (memsetp
2270 ? SET_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)
2271 : STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)))
2272 return 0;
2274 tmode = mode_for_size (STORE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
2275 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
2276 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
2277 else
2279 enum machine_mode xmode;
2281 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
2282 tmode != VOIDmode;
2283 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2284 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > STORE_MAX_PIECES
2285 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
2286 break;
2288 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
2291 /* We would first store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2292 successively smaller modes. */
2294 for (reverse = 0;
2295 reverse <= (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT || HAVE_POST_DECREMENT);
2296 reverse++)
2298 l = len;
2299 mode = VOIDmode;
2300 max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2301 while (max_size > 1)
2303 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2304 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2305 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
2306 mode = tmode;
2308 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2309 break;
2311 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
2312 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
2313 && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2315 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2317 while (l >= size)
2319 if (reverse)
2320 offset -= size;
2322 cst = (*constfun) (constfundata, offset, mode);
2323 if (!LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (cst))
2324 return 0;
2326 if (!reverse)
2327 offset += size;
2329 l -= size;
2333 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2336 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2337 gcc_assert (!l);
2340 return 1;
2343 /* Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes generated by
2344 CONSTFUN to block TO. (A MEM rtx with BLKmode). CONSTFUNDATA is a
2345 pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2346 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
2347 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
2348 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
2349 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
2350 stpcpy. */
2353 store_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2354 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
2355 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp, int endp)
2357 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode
2358 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (to));
2359 struct store_by_pieces_d data;
2361 if (len == 0)
2363 gcc_assert (endp != 2);
2364 return to;
2367 gcc_assert (memsetp
2368 ? SET_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)
2369 : STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align));
2370 data.constfun = constfun;
2371 data.constfundata = constfundata;
2372 data.len = len;
2373 data.to = to;
2374 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2375 if (endp)
2377 rtx to1;
2379 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
2380 if (data.autinc_to)
2382 if (endp == 2)
2384 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
2385 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
2386 else
2387 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
2388 plus_constant (data.to_addr,
2389 -1));
2391 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
2392 data.offset);
2394 else
2396 if (endp == 2)
2397 --data.offset;
2398 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
2400 return to1;
2402 else
2403 return data.to;
2406 /* Generate several move instructions to clear LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2407 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2409 static void
2410 clear_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
2412 struct store_by_pieces_d data;
2414 if (len == 0)
2415 return;
2417 data.constfun = clear_by_pieces_1;
2418 data.constfundata = NULL;
2419 data.len = len;
2420 data.to = to;
2421 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2424 /* Callback routine for clear_by_pieces.
2425 Return const0_rtx unconditionally. */
2427 static rtx
2428 clear_by_pieces_1 (void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2429 HOST_WIDE_INT offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2430 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2432 return const0_rtx;
2435 /* Subroutine of clear_by_pieces and store_by_pieces.
2436 Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2437 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2439 static void
2440 store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces_d *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2441 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2443 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode
2444 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (data->to));
2445 rtx to_addr = XEXP (data->to, 0);
2446 unsigned int max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2447 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
2448 enum insn_code icode;
2450 data->offset = 0;
2451 data->to_addr = to_addr;
2452 data->autinc_to
2453 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
2454 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2456 data->explicit_inc_to = 0;
2457 data->reverse
2458 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2459 if (data->reverse)
2460 data->offset = data->len;
2462 /* If storing requires more than two move insns,
2463 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
2464 and use post-increment if available. */
2465 if (!data->autinc_to
2466 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (data->len, align, max_size) > 2)
2468 /* Determine the main mode we'll be using. */
2469 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2470 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2471 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
2472 mode = tmode;
2474 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data->reverse && ! data->autinc_to)
2476 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
2477 plus_constant (to_addr, data->len));
2478 data->autinc_to = 1;
2479 data->explicit_inc_to = -1;
2482 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data->reverse
2483 && ! data->autinc_to)
2485 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
2486 data->autinc_to = 1;
2487 data->explicit_inc_to = 1;
2490 if ( !data->autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
2491 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
2494 tmode = mode_for_size (STORE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
2495 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
2496 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
2497 else
2499 enum machine_mode xmode;
2501 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
2502 tmode != VOIDmode;
2503 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2504 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > STORE_MAX_PIECES
2505 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
2506 break;
2508 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
2511 /* First store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2512 successively smaller modes. */
2514 while (max_size > 1)
2516 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2517 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2518 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
2519 mode = tmode;
2521 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2522 break;
2524 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
2525 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2526 store_by_pieces_2 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, data);
2528 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2531 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2532 gcc_assert (!data->len);
2535 /* Subroutine of store_by_pieces_1. Store as many bytes as appropriate
2536 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
2537 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
2539 static void
2540 store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
2541 struct store_by_pieces_d *data)
2543 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2544 rtx to1, cst;
2546 while (data->len >= size)
2548 if (data->reverse)
2549 data->offset -= size;
2551 if (data->autinc_to)
2552 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
2553 data->offset);
2554 else
2555 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
2557 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
2558 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
2559 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) size)));
2561 cst = (*data->constfun) (data->constfundata, data->offset, mode);
2562 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, cst));
2564 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
2565 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
2567 if (! data->reverse)
2568 data->offset += size;
2570 data->len -= size;
2574 /* Write zeros through the storage of OBJECT. If OBJECT has BLKmode, SIZE is
2575 its length in bytes. */
2578 clear_storage_hints (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
2579 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
2581 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (object);
2582 unsigned int align;
2584 gcc_assert (method == BLOCK_OP_NORMAL || method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
2586 /* If OBJECT is not BLKmode and SIZE is the same size as its mode,
2587 just move a zero. Otherwise, do this a piece at a time. */
2588 if (mode != BLKmode
2589 && CONST_INT_P (size)
2590 && INTVAL (size) == (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2592 rtx zero = CONST0_RTX (mode);
2593 if (zero != NULL)
2595 emit_move_insn (object, zero);
2596 return NULL;
2599 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
2601 zero = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
2602 if (zero != NULL)
2604 write_complex_part (object, zero, 0);
2605 write_complex_part (object, zero, 1);
2606 return NULL;
2611 if (size == const0_rtx)
2612 return NULL;
2614 align = MEM_ALIGN (object);
2616 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
2617 && CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
2618 clear_by_pieces (object, INTVAL (size), align);
2619 else if (set_storage_via_setmem (object, size, const0_rtx, align,
2620 expected_align, expected_size))
2622 else if (ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (object)))
2623 return set_storage_via_libcall (object, size, const0_rtx,
2624 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
2625 else
2626 gcc_unreachable ();
2628 return NULL;
2632 clear_storage (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
2634 return clear_storage_hints (object, size, method, 0, -1);
2638 /* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a call to memset.
2639 Return the return value of memset, 0 otherwise. */
2642 set_storage_via_libcall (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, bool tailcall)
2644 tree call_expr, fn, object_tree, size_tree, val_tree;
2645 enum machine_mode size_mode;
2646 rtx retval;
2648 /* Emit code to copy OBJECT and SIZE into new pseudos. We can then
2649 place those into new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and use them later. */
2651 object = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (object, 0));
2653 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
2654 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
2655 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
2657 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
2658 memset in this context. This could be a user call to memset and
2659 the user may wish to examine the return value from memset. For
2660 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
2661 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
2663 object_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, object);
2664 if (!CONST_INT_P (val))
2665 val = convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), val, 1);
2666 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
2667 val_tree = make_tree (integer_type_node, val);
2669 fn = clear_storage_libcall_fn (true);
2670 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, object_tree, val_tree, size_tree);
2671 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
2673 retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
2675 return retval;
2678 /* A subroutine of set_storage_via_libcall. Create the tree node
2679 for the function we use for block clears. The first time FOR_CALL
2680 is true, we call assemble_external. */
2682 tree block_clear_fn;
2684 void
2685 init_block_clear_fn (const char *asmspec)
2687 if (!block_clear_fn)
2689 tree fn, args;
2691 fn = get_identifier ("memset");
2692 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
2693 integer_type_node, sizetype,
2694 NULL_TREE);
2696 fn = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
2697 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
2698 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
2699 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
2700 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
2701 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
2702 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
2704 block_clear_fn = fn;
2707 if (asmspec)
2708 set_user_assembler_name (block_clear_fn, asmspec);
2711 static tree
2712 clear_storage_libcall_fn (int for_call)
2714 static bool emitted_extern;
2716 if (!block_clear_fn)
2717 init_block_clear_fn (NULL);
2719 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
2721 emitted_extern = true;
2722 make_decl_rtl (block_clear_fn);
2723 assemble_external (block_clear_fn);
2726 return block_clear_fn;
2729 /* Expand a setmem pattern; return true if successful. */
2731 bool
2732 set_storage_via_setmem (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, unsigned int align,
2733 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
2735 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
2736 including more than one in the machine description unless
2737 the more limited one has some advantage. */
2739 rtx opalign = GEN_INT (align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2740 enum machine_mode mode;
2742 if (expected_align < align)
2743 expected_align = align;
2745 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
2746 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
2748 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (setmem_optab, mode);
2749 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
2751 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
2752 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than
2753 BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT here because if SIZE is less than
2754 the mode mask, as it is returned by the macro, it will
2755 definitely be less than the actual mode mask. */
2756 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
2757 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
2758 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
2759 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD)
2760 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[0].predicate) == 0
2761 || (*pred) (object, BLKmode))
2762 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[3].predicate) == 0
2763 || (*pred) (opalign, VOIDmode)))
2765 rtx opsize, opchar;
2766 enum machine_mode char_mode;
2767 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
2768 rtx pat;
2770 opsize = convert_to_mode (mode, size, 1);
2771 pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[1].predicate;
2772 if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (opsize, mode))
2773 opsize = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, opsize);
2775 opchar = val;
2776 char_mode = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].mode;
2777 if (char_mode != VOIDmode)
2779 opchar = convert_to_mode (char_mode, opchar, 1);
2780 pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].predicate;
2781 if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (opchar, char_mode))
2782 opchar = copy_to_mode_reg (char_mode, opchar);
2785 if (insn_data[(int) code].n_operands == 4)
2786 pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (object, opsize, opchar, opalign);
2787 else
2788 pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (object, opsize, opchar, opalign,
2789 GEN_INT (expected_align
2790 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
2791 GEN_INT (expected_size));
2792 if (pat)
2794 emit_insn (pat);
2795 return true;
2797 else
2798 delete_insns_since (last);
2802 return false;
2806 /* Write to one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Write VAL to
2807 the real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if its true. */
2809 static void
2810 write_complex_part (rtx cplx, rtx val, bool imag_p)
2812 enum machine_mode cmode;
2813 enum machine_mode imode;
2814 unsigned ibitsize;
2816 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
2818 emit_move_insn (XEXP (cplx, imag_p), val);
2819 return;
2822 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
2823 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
2824 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
2826 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
2827 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
2828 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
2829 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
2830 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
2831 if (MEM_P (cplx))
2833 emit_move_insn (adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
2834 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0),
2835 val);
2836 return;
2839 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
2840 will work. This special case is important, since store_bit_field
2841 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
2842 correspond to TCmode. */
2843 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
2844 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
2845 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
2846 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
2847 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
2848 || (REG_P (cplx)
2849 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2850 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
2852 rtx part = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
2853 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
2854 if (part)
2856 emit_move_insn (part, val);
2857 return;
2859 else
2860 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
2861 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
2864 store_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0, imode, val);
2867 /* Extract one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Extract the
2868 real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if it's true. */
2870 static rtx
2871 read_complex_part (rtx cplx, bool imag_p)
2873 enum machine_mode cmode, imode;
2874 unsigned ibitsize;
2876 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
2877 return XEXP (cplx, imag_p);
2879 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
2880 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
2881 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
2883 /* Special case reads from complex constants that got spilled to memory. */
2884 if (MEM_P (cplx) && GET_CODE (XEXP (cplx, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
2886 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (cplx, 0));
2887 if (decl && TREE_CODE (decl) == COMPLEX_CST)
2889 tree part = imag_p ? TREE_IMAGPART (decl) : TREE_REALPART (decl);
2890 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (part))
2891 return expand_expr (part, NULL_RTX, imode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
2895 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
2896 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
2897 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
2898 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
2899 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
2900 if (MEM_P (cplx))
2901 return adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
2902 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
2904 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
2905 will work. This special case is important, since extract_bit_field
2906 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
2907 correspond to TCmode. */
2908 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
2909 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
2910 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
2911 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
2912 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
2913 || (REG_P (cplx)
2914 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2915 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
2917 rtx ret = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
2918 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
2919 if (ret)
2920 return ret;
2921 else
2922 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
2923 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
2926 return extract_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0,
2927 true, NULL_RTX, imode, imode);
2930 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Yet another lowpart generator.
2931 NEW_MODE and OLD_MODE are the same size. Return NULL if X cannot be
2932 represented in NEW_MODE. If FORCE is true, this will never happen, as
2933 we'll force-create a SUBREG if needed. */
2935 static rtx
2936 emit_move_change_mode (enum machine_mode new_mode,
2937 enum machine_mode old_mode, rtx x, bool force)
2939 rtx ret;
2941 if (push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
2943 ret = gen_rtx_MEM (new_mode, XEXP (x, 0));
2944 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (ret, x);
2946 else if (MEM_P (x))
2948 /* We don't have to worry about changing the address since the
2949 size in bytes is supposed to be the same. */
2950 if (reload_in_progress)
2952 /* Copy the MEM to change the mode and move any
2953 substitutions from the old MEM to the new one. */
2954 ret = adjust_address_nv (x, new_mode, 0);
2955 copy_replacements (x, ret);
2957 else
2958 ret = adjust_address (x, new_mode, 0);
2960 else
2962 /* Note that we do want simplify_subreg's behavior of validating
2963 that the new mode is ok for a hard register. If we were to use
2964 simplify_gen_subreg, we would create the subreg, but would
2965 probably run into the target not being able to implement it. */
2966 /* Except, of course, when FORCE is true, when this is exactly what
2967 we want. Which is needed for CCmodes on some targets. */
2968 if (force)
2969 ret = simplify_gen_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
2970 else
2971 ret = simplify_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
2974 return ret;
2977 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X using
2978 an integer mode of the same size as MODE. Returns the instruction
2979 emitted, or NULL if such a move could not be generated. */
2981 static rtx
2982 emit_move_via_integer (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y, bool force)
2984 enum machine_mode imode;
2985 enum insn_code code;
2987 /* There must exist a mode of the exact size we require. */
2988 imode = int_mode_for_mode (mode);
2989 if (imode == BLKmode)
2990 return NULL_RTX;
2992 /* The target must support moves in this mode. */
2993 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, imode);
2994 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
2995 return NULL_RTX;
2997 x = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, x, force);
2998 if (x == NULL_RTX)
2999 return NULL_RTX;
3000 y = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, y, force);
3001 if (y == NULL_RTX)
3002 return NULL_RTX;
3003 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3006 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. X is a push_operand in MODE.
3007 Return an equivalent MEM that does not use an auto-increment. */
3009 static rtx
3010 emit_move_resolve_push (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x)
3012 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
3013 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust;
3014 rtx temp;
3016 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3017 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3018 adjust = PUSH_ROUNDING (adjust);
3019 #endif
3020 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
3021 adjust = -adjust;
3022 else if (code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
3024 rtx expr = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
3025 HOST_WIDE_INT val;
3027 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == PLUS || GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS);
3028 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (expr, 1)));
3029 val = INTVAL (XEXP (expr, 1));
3030 if (GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS)
3031 val = -val;
3032 gcc_assert (adjust == val || adjust == -val);
3033 adjust = val;
3036 /* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
3037 stack_pointer_delta. */
3038 temp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, stack_pointer_rtx,
3039 GEN_INT (adjust), stack_pointer_rtx,
3040 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3041 if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
3042 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
3044 switch (code)
3046 case PRE_INC:
3047 case PRE_DEC:
3048 case PRE_MODIFY:
3049 temp = stack_pointer_rtx;
3050 break;
3051 case POST_INC:
3052 case POST_DEC:
3053 case POST_MODIFY:
3054 temp = plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, -adjust);
3055 break;
3056 default:
3057 gcc_unreachable ();
3060 return replace_equiv_address (x, temp);
3063 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Generate a move from Y into X.
3064 X is known to satisfy push_operand, and MODE is known to be complex.
3065 Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3068 emit_move_complex_push (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3070 enum machine_mode submode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
3071 bool imag_first;
3073 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3074 unsigned int submodesize = GET_MODE_SIZE (submode);
3076 /* In case we output to the stack, but the size is smaller than the
3077 machine can push exactly, we need to use move instructions. */
3078 if (PUSH_ROUNDING (submodesize) != submodesize)
3080 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3081 return emit_move_insn (x, y);
3083 #endif
3085 /* Note that the real part always precedes the imag part in memory
3086 regardless of machine's endianness. */
3087 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
3089 case PRE_DEC:
3090 case POST_DEC:
3091 imag_first = true;
3092 break;
3093 case PRE_INC:
3094 case POST_INC:
3095 imag_first = false;
3096 break;
3097 default:
3098 gcc_unreachable ();
3101 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3102 read_complex_part (y, imag_first));
3103 return emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3104 read_complex_part (y, !imag_first));
3107 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Perform the move from Y to X
3108 via two moves of the parts. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3111 emit_move_complex_parts (rtx x, rtx y)
3113 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3114 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3115 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values. */
3116 if (!reload_completed && !reload_in_progress
3117 && REG_P (x) && !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, y))
3118 emit_clobber (x);
3120 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, false), false);
3121 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, true), true);
3123 return get_last_insn ();
3126 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3127 MODE is known to be complex. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3129 static rtx
3130 emit_move_complex (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3132 bool try_int;
3134 /* Need to take special care for pushes, to maintain proper ordering
3135 of the data, and possibly extra padding. */
3136 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3137 return emit_move_complex_push (mode, x, y);
3139 /* See if we can coerce the target into moving both values at once. */
3141 /* Move floating point as parts. */
3142 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
3143 && optab_handler (mov_optab, GET_MODE_INNER (mode)) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3144 try_int = false;
3145 /* Not possible if the values are inherently not adjacent. */
3146 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (y) == CONCAT)
3147 try_int = false;
3148 /* Is possible if both are registers (or subregs of registers). */
3149 else if (register_operand (x, mode) && register_operand (y, mode))
3150 try_int = true;
3151 /* If one of the operands is a memory, and alignment constraints
3152 are friendly enough, we may be able to do combined memory operations.
3153 We do not attempt this if Y is a constant because that combination is
3154 usually better with the by-parts thing below. */
3155 else if ((MEM_P (x) ? !CONSTANT_P (y) : MEM_P (y))
3156 && (!STRICT_ALIGNMENT
3157 || get_mode_alignment (mode) == BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT))
3158 try_int = true;
3159 else
3160 try_int = false;
3162 if (try_int)
3164 rtx ret;
3166 /* For memory to memory moves, optimal behavior can be had with the
3167 existing block move logic. */
3168 if (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y))
3170 emit_block_move (x, y, GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
3171 BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL);
3172 return get_last_insn ();
3175 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3176 if (ret)
3177 return ret;
3180 return emit_move_complex_parts (x, y);
3183 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3184 MODE is known to be MODE_CC. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3186 static rtx
3187 emit_move_ccmode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3189 rtx ret;
3191 /* Assume all MODE_CC modes are equivalent; if we have movcc, use it. */
3192 if (mode != CCmode)
3194 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (mov_optab, CCmode);
3195 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3197 x = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, x, true);
3198 y = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, y, true);
3199 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3203 /* Otherwise, find the MODE_INT mode of the same width. */
3204 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
3205 gcc_assert (ret != NULL);
3206 return ret;
3209 /* Return true if word I of OP lies entirely in the
3210 undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3212 static bool
3213 undefined_operand_subword_p (const_rtx op, int i)
3215 enum machine_mode innermode, innermostmode;
3216 int offset;
3217 if (GET_CODE (op) != SUBREG)
3218 return false;
3219 innermode = GET_MODE (op);
3220 innermostmode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op));
3221 offset = i * UNITS_PER_WORD + SUBREG_BYTE (op);
3222 /* The SUBREG_BYTE represents offset, as if the value were stored in
3223 memory, except for a paradoxical subreg where we define
3224 SUBREG_BYTE to be 0; undo this exception as in
3225 simplify_subreg. */
3226 if (SUBREG_BYTE (op) == 0
3227 && GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode))
3229 int difference = (GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) - GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode));
3230 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
3231 offset += (difference / UNITS_PER_WORD) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
3232 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
3233 offset += difference % UNITS_PER_WORD;
3235 if (offset >= GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode)
3236 || offset <= -GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
3237 return true;
3238 return false;
3241 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3242 MODE is any multi-word or full-word mode that lacks a move_insn
3243 pattern. Note that you will get better code if you define such
3244 patterns, even if they must turn into multiple assembler instructions. */
3246 static rtx
3247 emit_move_multi_word (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3249 rtx last_insn = 0;
3250 rtx seq, inner;
3251 bool need_clobber;
3252 int i;
3254 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= UNITS_PER_WORD);
3256 /* If X is a push on the stack, do the push now and replace
3257 X with a reference to the stack pointer. */
3258 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3259 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3261 /* If we are in reload, see if either operand is a MEM whose address
3262 is scheduled for replacement. */
3263 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (x)
3264 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (x, 0))) != XEXP (x, 0))
3265 x = replace_equiv_address_nv (x, inner);
3266 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (y)
3267 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (y, 0))) != XEXP (y, 0))
3268 y = replace_equiv_address_nv (y, inner);
3270 start_sequence ();
3272 need_clobber = false;
3273 for (i = 0;
3274 i < (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3275 i++)
3277 rtx xpart = operand_subword (x, i, 1, mode);
3278 rtx ypart;
3280 /* Do not generate code for a move if it would come entirely
3281 from the undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3282 if (undefined_operand_subword_p (y, i))
3283 continue;
3285 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3287 /* If we can't get a part of Y, put Y into memory if it is a
3288 constant. Otherwise, force it into a register. Then we must
3289 be able to get a part of Y. */
3290 if (ypart == 0 && CONSTANT_P (y))
3292 y = use_anchored_address (force_const_mem (mode, y));
3293 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3295 else if (ypart == 0)
3296 ypart = operand_subword_force (y, i, mode);
3298 gcc_assert (xpart && ypart);
3300 need_clobber |= (GET_CODE (xpart) == SUBREG);
3302 last_insn = emit_move_insn (xpart, ypart);
3305 seq = get_insns ();
3306 end_sequence ();
3308 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3309 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3310 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
3311 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
3312 if (x != y
3313 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
3314 && need_clobber != 0)
3315 emit_clobber (x);
3317 emit_insn (seq);
3319 return last_insn;
3322 /* Low level part of emit_move_insn.
3323 Called just like emit_move_insn, but assumes X and Y
3324 are basically valid. */
3327 emit_move_insn_1 (rtx x, rtx y)
3329 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3330 enum insn_code code;
3332 gcc_assert ((unsigned int) mode < (unsigned int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE);
3334 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
3335 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3336 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3338 /* Expand complex moves by moving real part and imag part. */
3339 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
3340 return emit_move_complex (mode, x, y);
3342 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_DECIMAL_FLOAT
3343 || ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
3345 rtx result = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3347 /* If we can't find an integer mode, use multi words. */
3348 if (result)
3349 return result;
3350 else
3351 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3354 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC)
3355 return emit_move_ccmode (mode, x, y);
3357 /* Try using a move pattern for the corresponding integer mode. This is
3358 only safe when simplify_subreg can convert MODE constants into integer
3359 constants. At present, it can only do this reliably if the value
3360 fits within a HOST_WIDE_INT. */
3361 if (!CONSTANT_P (y) || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
3363 rtx ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
3364 if (ret)
3365 return ret;
3368 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3371 /* Generate code to copy Y into X.
3372 Both Y and X must have the same mode, except that
3373 Y can be a constant with VOIDmode.
3374 This mode cannot be BLKmode; use emit_block_move for that.
3376 Return the last instruction emitted. */
3379 emit_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
3381 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3382 rtx y_cst = NULL_RTX;
3383 rtx last_insn, set;
3385 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode
3386 && (GET_MODE (y) == mode || GET_MODE (y) == VOIDmode));
3388 if (CONSTANT_P (y))
3390 if (optimize
3391 && SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
3392 && (last_insn = compress_float_constant (x, y)))
3393 return last_insn;
3395 y_cst = y;
3397 if (!LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (y))
3399 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
3401 /* If the target's cannot_force_const_mem prevented the spill,
3402 assume that the target's move expanders will also take care
3403 of the non-legitimate constant. */
3404 if (!y)
3405 y = y_cst;
3406 else
3407 y = use_anchored_address (y);
3411 /* If X or Y are memory references, verify that their addresses are valid
3412 for the machine. */
3413 if (MEM_P (x)
3414 && (! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
3415 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
3416 && ! push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x))))
3417 x = validize_mem (x);
3419 if (MEM_P (y)
3420 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (y), XEXP (y, 0),
3421 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
3422 y = validize_mem (y);
3424 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
3426 last_insn = emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
3428 if (y_cst && REG_P (x)
3429 && (set = single_set (last_insn)) != NULL_RTX
3430 && SET_DEST (set) == x
3431 && ! rtx_equal_p (y_cst, SET_SRC (set)))
3432 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y_cst);
3434 return last_insn;
3437 /* If Y is representable exactly in a narrower mode, and the target can
3438 perform the extension directly from constant or memory, then emit the
3439 move as an extension. */
3441 static rtx
3442 compress_float_constant (rtx x, rtx y)
3444 enum machine_mode dstmode = GET_MODE (x);
3445 enum machine_mode orig_srcmode = GET_MODE (y);
3446 enum machine_mode srcmode;
3447 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
3448 int oldcost, newcost;
3449 bool speed = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
3451 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, y);
3453 if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (y))
3454 oldcost = rtx_cost (y, SET, speed);
3455 else
3456 oldcost = rtx_cost (force_const_mem (dstmode, y), SET, speed);
3458 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (GET_MODE_CLASS (orig_srcmode));
3459 srcmode != orig_srcmode;
3460 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
3462 enum insn_code ic;
3463 rtx trunc_y, last_insn;
3465 /* Skip if the target can't extend this way. */
3466 ic = can_extend_p (dstmode, srcmode, 0);
3467 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3468 continue;
3470 /* Skip if the narrowed value isn't exact. */
3471 if (! exact_real_truncate (srcmode, &r))
3472 continue;
3474 trunc_y = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (r, srcmode);
3476 if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (trunc_y))
3478 /* Skip if the target needs extra instructions to perform
3479 the extension. */
3480 if (! (*insn_data[ic].operand[1].predicate) (trunc_y, srcmode))
3481 continue;
3482 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3483 newcost = rtx_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y), SET, speed);
3484 if (oldcost < newcost)
3485 continue;
3487 else if (float_extend_from_mem[dstmode][srcmode])
3489 trunc_y = force_const_mem (srcmode, trunc_y);
3490 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3491 newcost = rtx_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y), SET, speed);
3492 if (oldcost < newcost)
3493 continue;
3494 trunc_y = validize_mem (trunc_y);
3496 else
3497 continue;
3499 /* For CSE's benefit, force the compressed constant pool entry
3500 into a new pseudo. This constant may be used in different modes,
3501 and if not, combine will put things back together for us. */
3502 trunc_y = force_reg (srcmode, trunc_y);
3503 emit_unop_insn (ic, x, trunc_y, UNKNOWN);
3504 last_insn = get_last_insn ();
3506 if (REG_P (x))
3507 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y);
3509 return last_insn;
3512 return NULL_RTX;
3515 /* Pushing data onto the stack. */
3517 /* Push a block of length SIZE (perhaps variable)
3518 and return an rtx to address the beginning of the block.
3519 The value may be virtual_outgoing_args_rtx.
3521 EXTRA is the number of bytes of padding to push in addition to SIZE.
3522 BELOW nonzero means this padding comes at low addresses;
3523 otherwise, the padding comes at high addresses. */
3526 push_block (rtx size, int extra, int below)
3528 rtx temp;
3530 size = convert_modes (Pmode, ptr_mode, size, 1);
3531 if (CONSTANT_P (size))
3532 anti_adjust_stack (plus_constant (size, extra));
3533 else if (REG_P (size) && extra == 0)
3534 anti_adjust_stack (size);
3535 else
3537 temp = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, size);
3538 if (extra != 0)
3539 temp = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, temp, GEN_INT (extra),
3540 temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3541 anti_adjust_stack (temp);
3544 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3545 if (0)
3546 #else
3547 if (1)
3548 #endif
3550 temp = virtual_outgoing_args_rtx;
3551 if (extra != 0 && below)
3552 temp = plus_constant (temp, extra);
3554 else
3556 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
3557 temp = plus_constant (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3558 -INTVAL (size) - (below ? 0 : extra));
3559 else if (extra != 0 && !below)
3560 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3561 negate_rtx (Pmode, plus_constant (size, extra)));
3562 else
3563 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3564 negate_rtx (Pmode, size));
3567 return memory_address (GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), temp);
3570 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3572 /* Emit single push insn. */
3574 static void
3575 emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
3577 rtx dest_addr;
3578 unsigned rounded_size = PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3579 rtx dest;
3580 enum insn_code icode;
3581 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
3583 stack_pointer_delta += PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3584 /* If there is push pattern, use it. Otherwise try old way of throwing
3585 MEM representing push operation to move expander. */
3586 icode = optab_handler (push_optab, mode);
3587 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3589 if (((pred = insn_data[(int) icode].operand[0].predicate)
3590 && !((*pred) (x, mode))))
3591 x = force_reg (mode, x);
3592 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (x));
3593 return;
3595 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == rounded_size)
3596 dest_addr = gen_rtx_fmt_e (STACK_PUSH_CODE, Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
3597 /* If we are to pad downward, adjust the stack pointer first and
3598 then store X into the stack location using an offset. This is
3599 because emit_move_insn does not know how to pad; it does not have
3600 access to type. */
3601 else if (FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type) == downward)
3603 unsigned padding_size = rounded_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3604 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
3606 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
3607 expand_binop (Pmode,
3608 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3609 sub_optab,
3610 #else
3611 add_optab,
3612 #endif
3613 stack_pointer_rtx,
3614 GEN_INT (rounded_size),
3615 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
3617 offset = (HOST_WIDE_INT) padding_size;
3618 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3619 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
3620 /* We have already decremented the stack pointer, so get the
3621 previous value. */
3622 offset += (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3623 #else
3624 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC)
3625 /* We have already incremented the stack pointer, so get the
3626 previous value. */
3627 offset -= (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3628 #endif
3629 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (offset));
3631 else
3633 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3634 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC. */
3635 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3636 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size));
3637 #else
3638 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC. */
3639 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3640 GEN_INT (rounded_size));
3641 #endif
3642 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PRE_MODIFY (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, dest_addr);
3645 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, dest_addr);
3647 if (type != 0)
3649 set_mem_attributes (dest, type, 1);
3651 if (flag_optimize_sibling_calls)
3652 /* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
3653 outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
3654 from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
3655 of sibling calls. */
3656 set_mem_alias_set (dest, 0);
3658 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
3660 #endif
3662 /* Generate code to push X onto the stack, assuming it has mode MODE and
3663 type TYPE.
3664 MODE is redundant except when X is a CONST_INT (since they don't
3665 carry mode info).
3666 SIZE is an rtx for the size of data to be copied (in bytes),
3667 needed only if X is BLKmode.
3669 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume.
3671 If PARTIAL and REG are both nonzero, then copy that many of the first
3672 bytes of X into registers starting with REG, and push the rest of X.
3673 The amount of space pushed is decreased by PARTIAL bytes.
3674 REG must be a hard register in this case.
3675 If REG is zero but PARTIAL is not, take any all others actions for an
3676 argument partially in registers, but do not actually load any
3677 registers.
3679 EXTRA is the amount in bytes of extra space to leave next to this arg.
3680 This is ignored if an argument block has already been allocated.
3682 On a machine that lacks real push insns, ARGS_ADDR is the address of
3683 the bottom of the argument block for this call. We use indexing off there
3684 to store the arg. On machines with push insns, ARGS_ADDR is 0 when a
3685 argument block has not been preallocated.
3687 ARGS_SO_FAR is the size of args previously pushed for this call.
3689 REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is nonzero if functions require stack space
3690 for arguments passed in registers. If nonzero, it will be the number
3691 of bytes required. */
3693 void
3694 emit_push_insn (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, tree type, rtx size,
3695 unsigned int align, int partial, rtx reg, int extra,
3696 rtx args_addr, rtx args_so_far, int reg_parm_stack_space,
3697 rtx alignment_pad)
3699 rtx xinner;
3700 enum direction stack_direction
3701 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3702 = downward;
3703 #else
3704 = upward;
3705 #endif
3707 /* Decide where to pad the argument: `downward' for below,
3708 `upward' for above, or `none' for don't pad it.
3709 Default is below for small data on big-endian machines; else above. */
3710 enum direction where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type);
3712 /* Invert direction if stack is post-decrement.
3713 FIXME: why? */
3714 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
3715 if (where_pad != none)
3716 where_pad = (where_pad == downward ? upward : downward);
3718 xinner = x;
3720 if (mode == BLKmode
3721 || (STRICT_ALIGNMENT && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
3723 /* Copy a block into the stack, entirely or partially. */
3725 rtx temp;
3726 int used;
3727 int offset;
3728 int skip;
3730 offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3731 used = partial - offset;
3733 if (mode != BLKmode)
3735 /* A value is to be stored in an insufficiently aligned
3736 stack slot; copy via a suitably aligned slot if
3737 necessary. */
3738 size = GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3739 if (!MEM_P (xinner))
3741 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
3742 emit_move_insn (temp, xinner);
3743 xinner = temp;
3747 gcc_assert (size);
3749 /* USED is now the # of bytes we need not copy to the stack
3750 because registers will take care of them. */
3752 if (partial != 0)
3753 xinner = adjust_address (xinner, BLKmode, used);
3755 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
3756 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
3757 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
3758 by setting SKIP to 0. */
3759 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : used;
3761 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3762 /* Do it with several push insns if that doesn't take lots of insns
3763 and if there is no difficulty with push insns that skip bytes
3764 on the stack for alignment purposes. */
3765 if (args_addr == 0
3766 && PUSH_ARGS
3767 && CONST_INT_P (size)
3768 && skip == 0
3769 && MEM_ALIGN (xinner) >= align
3770 && (MOVE_BY_PIECES_P ((unsigned) INTVAL (size) - used, align))
3771 /* Here we avoid the case of a structure whose weak alignment
3772 forces many pushes of a small amount of data,
3773 and such small pushes do rounding that causes trouble. */
3774 && ((! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align))
3775 || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
3776 || (PUSH_ROUNDING (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)
3777 == (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)))
3778 && PUSH_ROUNDING (INTVAL (size)) == INTVAL (size))
3780 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
3781 or if padding below and stack grows up.
3782 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
3783 if (extra && args_addr == 0
3784 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
3785 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3787 move_by_pieces (NULL, xinner, INTVAL (size) - used, align, 0);
3789 else
3790 #endif /* PUSH_ROUNDING */
3792 rtx target;
3794 /* Otherwise make space on the stack and copy the data
3795 to the address of that space. */
3797 /* Deduct words put into registers from the size we must copy. */
3798 if (partial != 0)
3800 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
3801 size = GEN_INT (INTVAL (size) - used);
3802 else
3803 size = expand_binop (GET_MODE (size), sub_optab, size,
3804 GEN_INT (used), NULL_RTX, 0,
3805 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3808 /* Get the address of the stack space.
3809 In this case, we do not deal with EXTRA separately.
3810 A single stack adjust will do. */
3811 if (! args_addr)
3813 temp = push_block (size, extra, where_pad == downward);
3814 extra = 0;
3816 else if (CONST_INT_P (args_so_far))
3817 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
3818 plus_constant (args_addr,
3819 skip + INTVAL (args_so_far)));
3820 else
3821 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
3822 plus_constant (gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
3823 args_addr,
3824 args_so_far),
3825 skip));
3827 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
3829 /* If the source is referenced relative to the stack pointer,
3830 copy it to another register to stabilize it. We do not need
3831 to do this if we know that we won't be changing sp. */
3833 if (reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, temp)
3834 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, temp))
3835 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
3838 target = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp);
3840 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
3841 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
3842 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
3843 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
3844 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
3845 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
3846 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
3847 set_mem_align (target, align);
3849 emit_block_move (target, xinner, size, BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM);
3852 else if (partial > 0)
3854 /* Scalar partly in registers. */
3856 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3857 int i;
3858 int not_stack;
3859 /* # bytes of start of argument
3860 that we must make space for but need not store. */
3861 int offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3862 int args_offset = INTVAL (args_so_far);
3863 int skip;
3865 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
3866 or if padding below and stack grows up.
3867 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
3868 if (extra && args_addr == 0
3869 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
3870 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3872 /* If we make space by pushing it, we might as well push
3873 the real data. Otherwise, we can leave OFFSET nonzero
3874 and leave the space uninitialized. */
3875 if (args_addr == 0)
3876 offset = 0;
3878 /* Now NOT_STACK gets the number of words that we don't need to
3879 allocate on the stack. Convert OFFSET to words too. */
3880 not_stack = (partial - offset) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3881 offset /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
3883 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
3884 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
3885 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
3886 by setting SKIP to 0. */
3887 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : not_stack;
3889 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && ! LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
3890 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
3892 /* If X is a hard register in a non-integer mode, copy it into a pseudo;
3893 SUBREGs of such registers are not allowed. */
3894 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3895 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT))
3896 x = copy_to_reg (x);
3898 /* Loop over all the words allocated on the stack for this arg. */
3899 /* We can do it by words, because any scalar bigger than a word
3900 has a size a multiple of a word. */
3901 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3902 for (i = not_stack; i < size; i++)
3903 #else
3904 for (i = size - 1; i >= not_stack; i--)
3905 #endif
3906 if (i >= not_stack + offset)
3907 emit_push_insn (operand_subword_force (x, i, mode),
3908 word_mode, NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX, align, 0, NULL_RTX,
3909 0, args_addr,
3910 GEN_INT (args_offset + ((i - not_stack + skip)
3911 * UNITS_PER_WORD)),
3912 reg_parm_stack_space, alignment_pad);
3914 else
3916 rtx addr;
3917 rtx dest;
3919 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
3920 or if padding below and stack grows up.
3921 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
3922 if (extra && args_addr == 0
3923 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
3924 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3926 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3927 if (args_addr == 0 && PUSH_ARGS)
3928 emit_single_push_insn (mode, x, type);
3929 else
3930 #endif
3932 if (CONST_INT_P (args_so_far))
3933 addr
3934 = memory_address (mode,
3935 plus_constant (args_addr,
3936 INTVAL (args_so_far)));
3937 else
3938 addr = memory_address (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, args_addr,
3939 args_so_far));
3940 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
3942 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
3943 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
3944 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
3945 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
3946 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
3947 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
3948 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
3949 set_mem_align (dest, align);
3951 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
3955 /* If part should go in registers, copy that part
3956 into the appropriate registers. Do this now, at the end,
3957 since mem-to-mem copies above may do function calls. */
3958 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0)
3960 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
3961 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
3962 if (GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
3963 emit_group_load (reg, x, type, -1);
3964 else
3966 gcc_assert (partial % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
3967 move_block_to_reg (REGNO (reg), x, partial / UNITS_PER_WORD, mode);
3971 if (extra && args_addr == 0 && where_pad == stack_direction)
3972 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3974 if (alignment_pad && args_addr == 0)
3975 anti_adjust_stack (alignment_pad);
3978 /* Return X if X can be used as a subtarget in a sequence of arithmetic
3979 operations. */
3981 static rtx
3982 get_subtarget (rtx x)
3984 return (optimize
3985 || x == 0
3986 /* Only registers can be subtargets. */
3987 || !REG_P (x)
3988 /* Don't use hard regs to avoid extending their life. */
3989 || REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3990 ? 0 : x);
3993 /* A subroutine of expand_assignment. Optimize FIELD op= VAL, where
3994 FIELD is a bitfield. Returns true if the optimization was successful,
3995 and there's nothing else to do. */
3997 static bool
3998 optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
3999 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
4000 enum machine_mode mode1, rtx str_rtx,
4001 tree to, tree src)
4003 enum machine_mode str_mode = GET_MODE (str_rtx);
4004 unsigned int str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
4005 tree op0, op1;
4006 rtx value, result;
4007 optab binop;
4009 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
4010 || bitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
4011 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD
4012 || TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (to)
4013 || TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (to))
4014 return false;
4016 STRIP_NOPS (src);
4017 if (!BINARY_CLASS_P (src)
4018 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) != INTEGER_TYPE)
4019 return false;
4021 op0 = TREE_OPERAND (src, 0);
4022 op1 = TREE_OPERAND (src, 1);
4023 STRIP_NOPS (op0);
4025 if (!operand_equal_p (to, op0, 0))
4026 return false;
4028 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4030 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset1;
4032 if (str_bitsize == 0 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD)
4033 str_mode = word_mode;
4034 str_mode = get_best_mode (bitsize, bitpos,
4035 MEM_ALIGN (str_rtx), str_mode, 0);
4036 if (str_mode == VOIDmode)
4037 return false;
4038 str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
4040 offset1 = bitpos;
4041 bitpos %= str_bitsize;
4042 offset1 = (offset1 - bitpos) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
4043 str_rtx = adjust_address (str_rtx, str_mode, offset1);
4045 else if (!REG_P (str_rtx) && GET_CODE (str_rtx) != SUBREG)
4046 return false;
4048 /* If the bit field covers the whole REG/MEM, store_field
4049 will likely generate better code. */
4050 if (bitsize >= str_bitsize)
4051 return false;
4053 /* We can't handle fields split across multiple entities. */
4054 if (bitpos + bitsize > str_bitsize)
4055 return false;
4057 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
4058 bitpos = str_bitsize - bitpos - bitsize;
4060 switch (TREE_CODE (src))
4062 case PLUS_EXPR:
4063 case MINUS_EXPR:
4064 /* For now, just optimize the case of the topmost bitfield
4065 where we don't need to do any masking and also
4066 1 bit bitfields where xor can be used.
4067 We might win by one instruction for the other bitfields
4068 too if insv/extv instructions aren't used, so that
4069 can be added later. */
4070 if (bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize
4071 && (bitsize != 1 || TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST))
4072 break;
4074 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4075 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
4076 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4077 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4079 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4080 we can alias adjacent data. */
4081 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4083 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4084 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4085 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4088 binop = TREE_CODE (src) == PLUS_EXPR ? add_optab : sub_optab;
4089 if (bitsize == 1 && bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
4091 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, const1_rtx, NULL);
4092 binop = xor_optab;
4094 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value,
4095 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, bitpos),
4096 NULL_RTX, 1);
4097 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
4098 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4099 if (result != str_rtx)
4100 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4101 return true;
4103 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
4104 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
4105 if (TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST)
4106 break;
4107 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (str_rtx), EXPAND_NORMAL);
4108 value = convert_modes (GET_MODE (str_rtx),
4109 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4110 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4112 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4113 we can alias adjacent data. */
4114 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4116 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4117 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4118 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4121 binop = TREE_CODE (src) == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? ior_optab : xor_optab;
4122 if (bitpos + bitsize != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (str_rtx)))
4124 rtx mask = GEN_INT (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize)
4125 - 1);
4126 value = expand_and (GET_MODE (str_rtx), value, mask,
4127 NULL_RTX);
4129 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (str_rtx), value,
4130 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, bitpos),
4131 NULL_RTX, 1);
4132 result = expand_binop (GET_MODE (str_rtx), binop, str_rtx,
4133 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4134 if (result != str_rtx)
4135 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4136 return true;
4138 default:
4139 break;
4142 return false;
4146 /* Expand an assignment that stores the value of FROM into TO. If NONTEMPORAL
4147 is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
4149 void
4150 expand_assignment (tree to, tree from, bool nontemporal)
4152 rtx to_rtx = 0;
4153 rtx result;
4155 /* Don't crash if the lhs of the assignment was erroneous. */
4156 if (TREE_CODE (to) == ERROR_MARK)
4158 result = expand_normal (from);
4159 return;
4162 /* Optimize away no-op moves without side-effects. */
4163 if (operand_equal_p (to, from, 0))
4164 return;
4166 /* Assignment of a structure component needs special treatment
4167 if the structure component's rtx is not simply a MEM.
4168 Assignment of an array element at a constant index, and assignment of
4169 an array element in an unaligned packed structure field, has the same
4170 problem. */
4171 if (handled_component_p (to)
4172 /* ??? We only need to handle MEM_REF here if the access is not
4173 a full access of the base object. */
4174 || (TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
4175 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (to, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR)
4176 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4178 enum machine_mode mode1;
4179 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
4180 tree offset;
4181 int unsignedp;
4182 int volatilep = 0;
4183 tree tem;
4185 push_temp_slots ();
4186 tem = get_inner_reference (to, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
4187 &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
4189 /* If we are going to use store_bit_field and extract_bit_field,
4190 make sure to_rtx will be safe for multiple use. */
4192 to_rtx = expand_normal (tem);
4194 /* If the bitfield is volatile, we want to access it in the
4195 field's mode, not the computed mode. */
4196 if (volatilep
4197 && GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM
4198 && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
4199 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, 0);
4201 if (offset != 0)
4203 enum machine_mode address_mode;
4204 rtx offset_rtx;
4206 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx))
4208 /* We can get constant negative offsets into arrays with broken
4209 user code. Translate this to a trap instead of ICEing. */
4210 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST);
4211 expand_builtin_trap ();
4212 to_rtx = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, const0_rtx);
4215 offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
4216 address_mode
4217 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (to_rtx));
4218 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
4219 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
4221 /* A constant address in TO_RTX can have VOIDmode, we must not try
4222 to call force_reg for that case. Avoid that case. */
4223 if (MEM_P (to_rtx)
4224 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode
4225 && GET_MODE (XEXP (to_rtx, 0)) != VOIDmode
4226 && bitsize > 0
4227 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
4228 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
4229 && MEM_ALIGN (to_rtx) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
4231 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4232 bitpos = 0;
4235 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
4236 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (to,
4237 offset));
4240 /* No action is needed if the target is not a memory and the field
4241 lies completely outside that target. This can occur if the source
4242 code contains an out-of-bounds access to a small array. */
4243 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx)
4244 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) != BLKmode
4245 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bitpos
4246 >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx)))
4248 expand_normal (from);
4249 result = NULL;
4251 /* Handle expand_expr of a complex value returning a CONCAT. */
4252 else if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == CONCAT)
4254 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from))))
4256 gcc_assert (bitpos == 0);
4257 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, false, nontemporal);
4259 else
4261 gcc_assert (bitpos == 0 || bitpos == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode1));
4262 result = store_expr (from, XEXP (to_rtx, bitpos != 0), false,
4263 nontemporal);
4266 else
4268 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
4270 /* If the field is at offset zero, we could have been given the
4271 DECL_RTX of the parent struct. Don't munge it. */
4272 to_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (to_rtx);
4274 set_mem_attributes_minus_bitpos (to_rtx, to, 0, bitpos);
4276 /* Deal with volatile and readonly fields. The former is only
4277 done for MEM. Also set MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P if needed. */
4278 if (volatilep)
4279 MEM_VOLATILE_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4280 if (component_uses_parent_alias_set (to))
4281 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4284 if (optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (bitsize, bitpos, mode1,
4285 to_rtx, to, from))
4286 result = NULL;
4287 else
4288 result = store_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode1, from,
4289 TREE_TYPE (tem), get_alias_set (to),
4290 nontemporal);
4293 if (result)
4294 preserve_temp_slots (result);
4295 free_temp_slots ();
4296 pop_temp_slots ();
4297 return;
4300 else if (TREE_CODE (to) == MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF)
4302 addr_space_t as = ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC;
4303 enum machine_mode mode, op_mode1;
4304 enum insn_code icode;
4305 rtx reg, addr, mem, insn;
4307 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (to, 0))))
4308 as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (to, 0))));
4310 reg = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4311 reg = force_not_mem (reg);
4313 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to));
4314 addr = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (to, 0), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
4315 EXPAND_SUM);
4316 addr = memory_address_addr_space (mode, addr, as);
4317 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
4319 set_mem_attributes (mem, to, 0);
4320 set_mem_addr_space (mem, as);
4322 icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode);
4323 gcc_assert (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing);
4325 op_mode1 = insn_data[icode].operand[1].mode;
4326 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[1].predicate) (reg, op_mode1)
4327 && op_mode1 != VOIDmode)
4328 reg = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode1, reg);
4330 insn = GEN_FCN (icode) (mem, reg);
4331 emit_insn (insn);
4332 return;
4335 /* If the rhs is a function call and its value is not an aggregate,
4336 call the function before we start to compute the lhs.
4337 This is needed for correct code for cases such as
4338 val = setjmp (buf) on machines where reference to val
4339 requires loading up part of an address in a separate insn.
4341 Don't do this if TO is a VAR_DECL or PARM_DECL whose DECL_RTL is REG
4342 since it might be a promoted variable where the zero- or sign- extension
4343 needs to be done. Handling this in the normal way is safe because no
4344 computation is done before the call. The same is true for SSA names. */
4345 if (TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR && ! aggregate_value_p (from, from)
4346 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (from))
4347 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) == INTEGER_CST
4348 && ! (((TREE_CODE (to) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (to) == PARM_DECL)
4349 && REG_P (DECL_RTL (to)))
4350 || TREE_CODE (to) == SSA_NAME))
4352 rtx value;
4354 push_temp_slots ();
4355 value = expand_normal (from);
4356 if (to_rtx == 0)
4357 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4359 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4360 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4361 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
4362 emit_group_load (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
4363 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4364 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode)
4365 emit_block_move (to_rtx, value, expr_size (from), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
4366 else
4368 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (to)))
4369 value = convert_memory_address_addr_space
4370 (GET_MODE (to_rtx), value,
4371 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (to))));
4373 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, value);
4375 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4376 free_temp_slots ();
4377 pop_temp_slots ();
4378 return;
4381 /* Ordinary treatment. Expand TO to get a REG or MEM rtx.
4382 Don't re-expand if it was expanded already (in COMPONENT_REF case). */
4384 if (to_rtx == 0)
4385 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4387 /* Don't move directly into a return register. */
4388 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
4389 && (REG_P (to_rtx) || GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL))
4391 rtx temp;
4393 push_temp_slots ();
4394 temp = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (to_rtx), EXPAND_NORMAL);
4396 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
4397 emit_group_load (to_rtx, temp, TREE_TYPE (from),
4398 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4399 else
4400 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
4402 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4403 free_temp_slots ();
4404 pop_temp_slots ();
4405 return;
4408 /* In case we are returning the contents of an object which overlaps
4409 the place the value is being stored, use a safe function when copying
4410 a value through a pointer into a structure value return block. */
4411 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
4412 && TREE_CODE (from) == INDIRECT_REF
4413 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P
4414 (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (from, 0)))))
4415 && refs_may_alias_p (to, from)
4416 && cfun->returns_struct
4417 && !cfun->returns_pcc_struct)
4419 rtx from_rtx, size;
4421 push_temp_slots ();
4422 size = expr_size (from);
4423 from_rtx = expand_normal (from);
4425 emit_library_call (memmove_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
4426 VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
4427 XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
4428 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
4429 size, TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
4430 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
4432 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4433 free_temp_slots ();
4434 pop_temp_slots ();
4435 return;
4438 /* Compute FROM and store the value in the rtx we got. */
4440 push_temp_slots ();
4441 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal);
4442 preserve_temp_slots (result);
4443 free_temp_slots ();
4444 pop_temp_slots ();
4445 return;
4448 /* Emits nontemporal store insn that moves FROM to TO. Returns true if this
4449 succeeded, false otherwise. */
4451 bool
4452 emit_storent_insn (rtx to, rtx from)
4454 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (to), imode;
4455 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (storent_optab, mode);
4456 rtx pattern;
4458 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
4459 return false;
4461 imode = insn_data[code].operand[0].mode;
4462 if (!insn_data[code].operand[0].predicate (to, imode))
4463 return false;
4465 imode = insn_data[code].operand[1].mode;
4466 if (!insn_data[code].operand[1].predicate (from, imode))
4468 from = copy_to_mode_reg (imode, from);
4469 if (!insn_data[code].operand[1].predicate (from, imode))
4470 return false;
4473 pattern = GEN_FCN (code) (to, from);
4474 if (pattern == NULL_RTX)
4475 return false;
4477 emit_insn (pattern);
4478 return true;
4481 /* Generate code for computing expression EXP,
4482 and storing the value into TARGET.
4484 If the mode is BLKmode then we may return TARGET itself.
4485 It turns out that in BLKmode it doesn't cause a problem.
4486 because C has no operators that could combine two different
4487 assignments into the same BLKmode object with different values
4488 with no sequence point. Will other languages need this to
4489 be more thorough?
4491 If CALL_PARAM_P is nonzero, this is a store into a call param on the
4492 stack, and block moves may need to be treated specially.
4494 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try using a nontemporal store instruction. */
4497 store_expr (tree exp, rtx target, int call_param_p, bool nontemporal)
4499 rtx temp;
4500 rtx alt_rtl = NULL_RTX;
4501 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
4503 if (VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
4505 /* C++ can generate ?: expressions with a throw expression in one
4506 branch and an rvalue in the other. Here, we resolve attempts to
4507 store the throw expression's nonexistent result. */
4508 gcc_assert (!call_param_p);
4509 expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4510 return NULL_RTX;
4512 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_EXPR)
4514 /* Perform first part of compound expression, then assign from second
4515 part. */
4516 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
4517 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
4518 return store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p,
4519 nontemporal);
4521 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COND_EXPR && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
4523 /* For conditional expression, get safe form of the target. Then
4524 test the condition, doing the appropriate assignment on either
4525 side. This avoids the creation of unnecessary temporaries.
4526 For non-BLKmode, it is more efficient not to do this. */
4528 rtx lab1 = gen_label_rtx (), lab2 = gen_label_rtx ();
4530 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
4531 NO_DEFER_POP;
4532 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), lab1, -1);
4533 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p,
4534 nontemporal);
4535 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (lab2));
4536 emit_barrier ();
4537 emit_label (lab1);
4538 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), target, call_param_p,
4539 nontemporal);
4540 emit_label (lab2);
4541 OK_DEFER_POP;
4543 return NULL_RTX;
4545 else if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (target))
4546 /* If this is a scalar in a register that is stored in a wider mode
4547 than the declared mode, compute the result into its declared mode
4548 and then convert to the wider mode. Our value is the computed
4549 expression. */
4551 rtx inner_target = 0;
4553 /* We can do the conversion inside EXP, which will often result
4554 in some optimizations. Do the conversion in two steps: first
4555 change the signedness, if needed, then the extend. But don't
4556 do this if the type of EXP is a subtype of something else
4557 since then the conversion might involve more than just
4558 converting modes. */
4559 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
4560 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == 0
4561 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (target))
4562 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
4564 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp))
4565 != SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target))
4567 /* Some types, e.g. Fortran's logical*4, won't have a signed
4568 version, so use the mode instead. */
4569 tree ntype
4570 = (signed_or_unsigned_type_for
4571 (SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target), TREE_TYPE (exp)));
4572 if (ntype == NULL)
4573 ntype = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
4574 (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
4575 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
4577 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, ntype, exp);
4580 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
4581 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
4582 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target)),
4583 exp);
4585 inner_target = SUBREG_REG (target);
4588 temp = expand_expr (exp, inner_target, VOIDmode,
4589 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
4591 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant, use convert_modes to make
4592 sure that we properly convert it. */
4593 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
4595 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
4596 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
4597 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
4598 GET_MODE (target), temp,
4599 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
4602 convert_move (SUBREG_REG (target), temp,
4603 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
4605 return NULL_RTX;
4607 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
4608 && !nontemporal && !call_param_p
4609 && TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp) > 0
4610 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == BLKmode)
4612 /* Optimize initialization of an array with a STRING_CST. */
4613 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_len, str_copy_len;
4614 rtx dest_mem;
4616 exp_len = int_expr_size (exp);
4617 if (exp_len <= 0)
4618 goto normal_expr;
4620 str_copy_len = strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (exp));
4621 if (str_copy_len < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp) - 1)
4622 goto normal_expr;
4624 str_copy_len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp);
4625 if ((STORE_MAX_PIECES & (STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1)) == 0)
4627 str_copy_len += STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1;
4628 str_copy_len &= ~(STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1);
4630 str_copy_len = MIN (str_copy_len, exp_len);
4631 if (!can_store_by_pieces (str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
4632 CONST_CAST(char *, TREE_STRING_POINTER (exp)),
4633 MEM_ALIGN (target), false))
4634 goto normal_expr;
4636 dest_mem = target;
4638 dest_mem = store_by_pieces (dest_mem,
4639 str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
4640 CONST_CAST(char *, TREE_STRING_POINTER (exp)),
4641 MEM_ALIGN (target), false,
4642 exp_len > str_copy_len ? 1 : 0);
4643 if (exp_len > str_copy_len)
4644 clear_storage (adjust_address (dest_mem, BLKmode, 0),
4645 GEN_INT (exp_len - str_copy_len),
4646 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
4647 return NULL_RTX;
4649 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
4650 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
4651 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)) == STRING_CST
4652 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
4653 && !nontemporal && !call_param_p
4654 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == BLKmode)
4656 /* Optimize initialization of an array with a STRING_CST. */
4657 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_len, str_copy_len;
4658 rtx dest_mem;
4659 tree str = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
4661 exp_len = int_expr_size (exp);
4662 if (exp_len <= 0)
4663 goto normal_expr;
4665 str_copy_len = strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (str));
4666 if (str_copy_len < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) - 1)
4667 goto normal_expr;
4669 str_copy_len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str);
4670 if ((STORE_MAX_PIECES & (STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1)) == 0)
4672 str_copy_len += STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1;
4673 str_copy_len &= ~(STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1);
4675 str_copy_len = MIN (str_copy_len, exp_len);
4676 if (!can_store_by_pieces (str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
4677 CONST_CAST(char *, TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)),
4678 MEM_ALIGN (target), false))
4679 goto normal_expr;
4681 dest_mem = target;
4683 dest_mem = store_by_pieces (dest_mem,
4684 str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
4685 CONST_CAST(char *, TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)),
4686 MEM_ALIGN (target), false,
4687 exp_len > str_copy_len ? 1 : 0);
4688 if (exp_len > str_copy_len)
4689 clear_storage (adjust_address (dest_mem, BLKmode, 0),
4690 GEN_INT (exp_len - str_copy_len),
4691 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
4692 return NULL_RTX;
4694 else
4696 rtx tmp_target;
4698 normal_expr:
4699 /* If we want to use a nontemporal store, force the value to
4700 register first. */
4701 tmp_target = nontemporal ? NULL_RTX : target;
4702 temp = expand_expr_real (exp, tmp_target, GET_MODE (target),
4703 (call_param_p
4704 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL),
4705 &alt_rtl);
4708 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant and the mode of the type of EXP is not
4709 the same as that of TARGET, adjust the constant. This is needed, for
4710 example, in case it is a CONST_DOUBLE and we want only a word-sized
4711 value. */
4712 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode
4713 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
4714 && GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
4715 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
4716 temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
4718 /* If value was not generated in the target, store it there.
4719 Convert the value to TARGET's type first if necessary and emit the
4720 pending incrementations that have been queued when expanding EXP.
4721 Note that we cannot emit the whole queue blindly because this will
4722 effectively disable the POST_INC optimization later.
4724 If TEMP and TARGET compare equal according to rtx_equal_p, but
4725 one or both of them are volatile memory refs, we have to distinguish
4726 two cases:
4727 - expand_expr has used TARGET. In this case, we must not generate
4728 another copy. This can be detected by TARGET being equal according
4729 to == .
4730 - expand_expr has not used TARGET - that means that the source just
4731 happens to have the same RTX form. Since temp will have been created
4732 by expand_expr, it will compare unequal according to == .
4733 We must generate a copy in this case, to reach the correct number
4734 of volatile memory references. */
4736 if ((! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
4737 || (temp != target && (side_effects_p (temp)
4738 || side_effects_p (target))))
4739 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
4740 /* If store_expr stores a DECL whose DECL_RTL(exp) == TARGET,
4741 but TARGET is not valid memory reference, TEMP will differ
4742 from TARGET although it is really the same location. */
4743 && !(alt_rtl && rtx_equal_p (alt_rtl, target))
4744 /* If there's nothing to copy, don't bother. Don't call
4745 expr_size unless necessary, because some front-ends (C++)
4746 expr_size-hook must not be given objects that are not
4747 supposed to be bit-copied or bit-initialized. */
4748 && expr_size (exp) != const0_rtx)
4750 if (GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target)
4751 && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
4753 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
4754 if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
4755 || GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
4756 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
4757 (call_param_p
4758 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM
4759 : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
4760 else
4761 convert_move (target, temp, unsignedp);
4764 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
4766 /* Handle copying a string constant into an array. The string
4767 constant may be shorter than the array. So copy just the string's
4768 actual length, and clear the rest. First get the size of the data
4769 type of the string, which is actually the size of the target. */
4770 rtx size = expr_size (exp);
4772 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
4773 && INTVAL (size) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp))
4774 emit_block_move (target, temp, size,
4775 (call_param_p
4776 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
4777 else
4779 enum machine_mode pointer_mode
4780 = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (target));
4781 enum machine_mode address_mode
4782 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (target));
4784 /* Compute the size of the data to copy from the string. */
4785 tree copy_size
4786 = size_binop_loc (loc, MIN_EXPR,
4787 make_tree (sizetype, size),
4788 size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp)));
4789 rtx copy_size_rtx
4790 = expand_expr (copy_size, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
4791 (call_param_p
4792 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
4793 rtx label = 0;
4795 /* Copy that much. */
4796 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (pointer_mode, copy_size_rtx,
4797 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
4798 emit_block_move (target, temp, copy_size_rtx,
4799 (call_param_p
4800 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
4802 /* Figure out how much is left in TARGET that we have to clear.
4803 Do all calculations in pointer_mode. */
4804 if (CONST_INT_P (copy_size_rtx))
4806 size = plus_constant (size, -INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
4807 target = adjust_address (target, BLKmode,
4808 INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
4810 else
4812 size = expand_binop (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), sub_optab, size,
4813 copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
4814 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
4816 if (GET_MODE (copy_size_rtx) != address_mode)
4817 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode,
4818 copy_size_rtx,
4819 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
4821 target = offset_address (target, copy_size_rtx,
4822 highest_pow2_factor (copy_size));
4823 label = gen_label_rtx ();
4824 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (size, const0_rtx, LT, NULL_RTX,
4825 GET_MODE (size), 0, label);
4828 if (size != const0_rtx)
4829 clear_storage (target, size, BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
4831 if (label)
4832 emit_label (label);
4835 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4836 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4837 else if (GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
4838 emit_group_load (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
4839 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
4840 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
4841 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
4842 (call_param_p
4843 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
4844 else if (nontemporal
4845 && emit_storent_insn (target, temp))
4846 /* If we managed to emit a nontemporal store, there is nothing else to
4847 do. */
4849 else
4851 temp = force_operand (temp, target);
4852 if (temp != target)
4853 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
4857 return NULL_RTX;
4860 /* Helper for categorize_ctor_elements. Identical interface. */
4862 static bool
4863 categorize_ctor_elements_1 (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
4864 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_elt_count,
4865 bool *p_must_clear)
4867 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
4868 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, elt_count;
4869 tree value, purpose;
4871 /* Whether CTOR is a valid constant initializer, in accordance with what
4872 initializer_constant_valid_p does. If inferred from the constructor
4873 elements, true until proven otherwise. */
4874 bool const_from_elts_p = constructor_static_from_elts_p (ctor);
4875 bool const_p = const_from_elts_p ? true : TREE_STATIC (ctor);
4877 nz_elts = 0;
4878 elt_count = 0;
4880 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor), idx, purpose, value)
4882 HOST_WIDE_INT mult = 1;
4884 if (TREE_CODE (purpose) == RANGE_EXPR)
4886 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 0);
4887 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 1);
4889 if (host_integerp (lo_index, 1) && host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
4890 mult = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
4891 - tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
4894 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
4896 case CONSTRUCTOR:
4898 HOST_WIDE_INT nz = 0, ic = 0;
4900 bool const_elt_p
4901 = categorize_ctor_elements_1 (value, &nz, &ic, p_must_clear);
4903 nz_elts += mult * nz;
4904 elt_count += mult * ic;
4906 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
4907 const_p = const_elt_p;
4909 break;
4911 case INTEGER_CST:
4912 case REAL_CST:
4913 case FIXED_CST:
4914 if (!initializer_zerop (value))
4915 nz_elts += mult;
4916 elt_count += mult;
4917 break;
4919 case STRING_CST:
4920 nz_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
4921 elt_count += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
4922 break;
4924 case COMPLEX_CST:
4925 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_REALPART (value)))
4926 nz_elts += mult;
4927 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_IMAGPART (value)))
4928 nz_elts += mult;
4929 elt_count += mult;
4930 break;
4932 case VECTOR_CST:
4934 tree v;
4935 for (v = TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (value); v; v = TREE_CHAIN (v))
4937 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_VALUE (v)))
4938 nz_elts += mult;
4939 elt_count += mult;
4942 break;
4944 default:
4946 HOST_WIDE_INT tc = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (value), true);
4947 if (tc < 1)
4948 tc = 1;
4949 nz_elts += mult * tc;
4950 elt_count += mult * tc;
4952 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
4953 const_p = initializer_constant_valid_p (value, TREE_TYPE (value))
4954 != NULL_TREE;
4956 break;
4960 if (!*p_must_clear
4961 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (ctor)) == UNION_TYPE
4962 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (ctor)) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE))
4964 tree init_sub_type;
4965 bool clear_this = true;
4967 if (!VEC_empty (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor)))
4969 /* We don't expect more than one element of the union to be
4970 initialized. Not sure what we should do otherwise... */
4971 gcc_assert (VEC_length (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor))
4972 == 1);
4974 init_sub_type = TREE_TYPE (VEC_index (constructor_elt,
4975 CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor),
4976 0)->value);
4978 /* ??? We could look at each element of the union, and find the
4979 largest element. Which would avoid comparing the size of the
4980 initialized element against any tail padding in the union.
4981 Doesn't seem worth the effort... */
4982 if (simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (ctor)),
4983 TYPE_SIZE (init_sub_type)) == 1)
4985 /* And now we have to find out if the element itself is fully
4986 constructed. E.g. for union { struct { int a, b; } s; } u
4987 = { .s = { .a = 1 } }. */
4988 if (elt_count == count_type_elements (init_sub_type, false))
4989 clear_this = false;
4993 *p_must_clear = clear_this;
4996 *p_nz_elts += nz_elts;
4997 *p_elt_count += elt_count;
4999 return const_p;
5002 /* Examine CTOR to discover:
5003 * how many scalar fields are set to nonzero values,
5004 and place it in *P_NZ_ELTS;
5005 * how many scalar fields in total are in CTOR,
5006 and place it in *P_ELT_COUNT.
5007 * if a type is a union, and the initializer from the constructor
5008 is not the largest element in the union, then set *p_must_clear.
5010 Return whether or not CTOR is a valid static constant initializer, the same
5011 as "initializer_constant_valid_p (CTOR, TREE_TYPE (CTOR)) != 0". */
5013 bool
5014 categorize_ctor_elements (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
5015 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_elt_count,
5016 bool *p_must_clear)
5018 *p_nz_elts = 0;
5019 *p_elt_count = 0;
5020 *p_must_clear = false;
5022 return
5023 categorize_ctor_elements_1 (ctor, p_nz_elts, p_elt_count, p_must_clear);
5026 /* Count the number of scalars in TYPE. Return -1 on overflow or
5027 variable-sized. If ALLOW_FLEXARR is true, don't count flexible
5028 array member at the end of the structure. */
5030 HOST_WIDE_INT
5031 count_type_elements (const_tree type, bool allow_flexarr)
5033 const HOST_WIDE_INT max = ~((HOST_WIDE_INT)1 << (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT-1));
5034 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
5036 case ARRAY_TYPE:
5038 tree telts = array_type_nelts (type);
5039 if (telts && host_integerp (telts, 1))
5041 HOST_WIDE_INT n = tree_low_cst (telts, 1) + 1;
5042 HOST_WIDE_INT m = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (type), false);
5043 if (n == 0)
5044 return 0;
5045 else if (max / n > m)
5046 return n * m;
5048 return -1;
5051 case RECORD_TYPE:
5053 HOST_WIDE_INT n = 0, t;
5054 tree f;
5056 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
5057 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
5059 t = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
5060 if (t < 0)
5062 /* Check for structures with flexible array member. */
5063 tree tf = TREE_TYPE (f);
5064 if (allow_flexarr
5065 && DECL_CHAIN (f) == NULL
5066 && TREE_CODE (tf) == ARRAY_TYPE
5067 && TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)
5068 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5069 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)))
5070 && !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5071 && int_size_in_bytes (type) >= 0)
5072 break;
5074 return -1;
5076 n += t;
5079 return n;
5082 case UNION_TYPE:
5083 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
5084 return -1;
5086 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
5087 return 2;
5089 case VECTOR_TYPE:
5090 return TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
5092 case INTEGER_TYPE:
5093 case REAL_TYPE:
5094 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
5095 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
5096 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
5097 case POINTER_TYPE:
5098 case OFFSET_TYPE:
5099 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
5100 return 1;
5102 case ERROR_MARK:
5103 return 0;
5105 case VOID_TYPE:
5106 case METHOD_TYPE:
5107 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
5108 case LANG_TYPE:
5109 default:
5110 gcc_unreachable ();
5114 /* Return 1 if EXP contains mostly (3/4) zeros. */
5116 static int
5117 mostly_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
5119 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5122 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, count, elts;
5123 bool must_clear;
5125 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &count, &must_clear);
5126 if (must_clear)
5127 return 1;
5129 elts = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (exp), false);
5131 return nz_elts < elts / 4;
5134 return initializer_zerop (exp);
5137 /* Return 1 if EXP contains all zeros. */
5139 static int
5140 all_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
5142 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5145 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, count;
5146 bool must_clear;
5148 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &count, &must_clear);
5149 return nz_elts == 0;
5152 return initializer_zerop (exp);
5155 /* Helper function for store_constructor.
5156 TARGET, BITSIZE, BITPOS, MODE, EXP are as for store_field.
5157 TYPE is the type of the CONSTRUCTOR, not the element type.
5158 CLEARED is as for store_constructor.
5159 ALIAS_SET is the alias set to use for any stores.
5161 This provides a recursive shortcut back to store_constructor when it isn't
5162 necessary to go through store_field. This is so that we can pass through
5163 the cleared field to let store_constructor know that we may not have to
5164 clear a substructure if the outer structure has already been cleared. */
5166 static void
5167 store_constructor_field (rtx target, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
5168 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, enum machine_mode mode,
5169 tree exp, tree type, int cleared,
5170 alias_set_type alias_set)
5172 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
5173 /* We can only call store_constructor recursively if the size and
5174 bit position are on a byte boundary. */
5175 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
5176 && (bitsize > 0 && bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0)
5177 /* If we have a nonzero bitpos for a register target, then we just
5178 let store_field do the bitfield handling. This is unlikely to
5179 generate unnecessary clear instructions anyways. */
5180 && (bitpos == 0 || MEM_P (target)))
5182 if (MEM_P (target))
5183 target
5184 = adjust_address (target,
5185 GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
5186 || 0 != (bitpos
5187 % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (GET_MODE (target)))
5188 ? BLKmode : VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5191 /* Update the alias set, if required. */
5192 if (MEM_P (target) && ! MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
5193 && MEM_ALIAS_SET (target) != 0)
5195 target = copy_rtx (target);
5196 set_mem_alias_set (target, alias_set);
5199 store_constructor (exp, target, cleared, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5201 else
5202 store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, exp, type, alias_set, false);
5205 /* Store the value of constructor EXP into the rtx TARGET.
5206 TARGET is either a REG or a MEM; we know it cannot conflict, since
5207 safe_from_p has been called.
5208 CLEARED is true if TARGET is known to have been zero'd.
5209 SIZE is the number of bytes of TARGET we are allowed to modify: this
5210 may not be the same as the size of EXP if we are assigning to a field
5211 which has been packed to exclude padding bits. */
5213 static void
5214 store_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, int cleared, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
5216 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
5217 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
5218 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
5219 #endif
5221 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
5223 case RECORD_TYPE:
5224 case UNION_TYPE:
5225 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
5227 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5228 tree field, value;
5230 /* If size is zero or the target is already cleared, do nothing. */
5231 if (size == 0 || cleared)
5232 cleared = 1;
5233 /* We either clear the aggregate or indicate the value is dead. */
5234 else if ((TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
5235 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
5236 && ! CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
5237 /* If the constructor is empty, clear the union. */
5239 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5240 cleared = 1;
5243 /* If we are building a static constructor into a register,
5244 set the initial value as zero so we can fold the value into
5245 a constant. But if more than one register is involved,
5246 this probably loses. */
5247 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp)
5248 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
5250 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
5251 cleared = 1;
5254 /* If the constructor has fewer fields than the structure or
5255 if we are initializing the structure to mostly zeros, clear
5256 the whole structure first. Don't do this if TARGET is a
5257 register whose mode size isn't equal to SIZE since
5258 clear_storage can't handle this case. */
5259 else if (size > 0
5260 && (((int)VEC_length (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
5261 != fields_length (type))
5262 || mostly_zeros_p (exp))
5263 && (!REG_P (target)
5264 || ((HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target))
5265 == size)))
5267 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5268 cleared = 1;
5271 if (REG_P (target) && !cleared)
5272 emit_clobber (target);
5274 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
5275 corresponding field of TARGET. */
5276 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, field, value)
5278 enum machine_mode mode;
5279 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
5280 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos = 0;
5281 tree offset;
5282 rtx to_rtx = target;
5284 /* Just ignore missing fields. We cleared the whole
5285 structure, above, if any fields are missing. */
5286 if (field == 0)
5287 continue;
5289 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
5290 continue;
5292 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (field), 1))
5293 bitsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (field), 1);
5294 else
5295 bitsize = -1;
5297 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
5298 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
5299 mode = VOIDmode;
5301 offset = DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field);
5302 if (host_integerp (offset, 0)
5303 && host_integerp (bit_position (field), 0))
5305 bitpos = int_bit_position (field);
5306 offset = 0;
5308 else
5309 bitpos = tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field), 0);
5311 if (offset)
5313 enum machine_mode address_mode;
5314 rtx offset_rtx;
5316 offset
5317 = SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (offset,
5318 make_tree (TREE_TYPE (exp),
5319 target));
5321 offset_rtx = expand_normal (offset);
5322 gcc_assert (MEM_P (to_rtx));
5324 address_mode
5325 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (to_rtx));
5326 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
5327 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
5329 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
5330 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
5333 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
5334 /* If this initializes a field that is smaller than a
5335 word, at the start of a word, try to widen it to a full
5336 word. This special case allows us to output C++ member
5337 function initializations in a form that the optimizers
5338 can understand. */
5339 if (REG_P (target)
5340 && bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
5341 && bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
5342 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5343 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST
5344 && exp_size >= 0
5345 && bitpos + BITS_PER_WORD <= exp_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
5347 tree type = TREE_TYPE (value);
5349 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) < BITS_PER_WORD)
5351 type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_size
5352 (BITS_PER_WORD, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
5353 value = fold_convert (type, value);
5356 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
5357 value
5358 = fold_build2 (LSHIFT_EXPR, type, value,
5359 build_int_cst (type,
5360 BITS_PER_WORD - bitsize));
5361 bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
5362 mode = word_mode;
5364 #endif
5366 if (MEM_P (to_rtx) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx)
5367 && DECL_NONADDRESSABLE_P (field))
5369 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
5370 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
5373 store_constructor_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode,
5374 value, type, cleared,
5375 get_alias_set (TREE_TYPE (field)));
5377 break;
5379 case ARRAY_TYPE:
5381 tree value, index;
5382 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i;
5383 int need_to_clear;
5384 tree domain;
5385 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
5386 int const_bounds_p;
5387 HOST_WIDE_INT minelt = 0;
5388 HOST_WIDE_INT maxelt = 0;
5390 domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
5391 const_bounds_p = (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)
5392 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
5393 && host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0)
5394 && host_integerp (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0));
5396 /* If we have constant bounds for the range of the type, get them. */
5397 if (const_bounds_p)
5399 minelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0);
5400 maxelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0);
5403 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the array, clear
5404 the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
5405 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
5406 if (cleared)
5407 need_to_clear = 0;
5408 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
5409 need_to_clear = 1;
5410 else
5412 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5413 tree index, value;
5414 HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
5415 need_to_clear = ! const_bounds_p;
5417 /* This loop is a more accurate version of the loop in
5418 mostly_zeros_p (it handles RANGE_EXPR in an index). It
5419 is also needed to check for missing elements. */
5420 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, index, value)
5422 HOST_WIDE_INT this_node_count;
5424 if (need_to_clear)
5425 break;
5427 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
5429 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
5430 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
5432 if (! host_integerp (lo_index, 1)
5433 || ! host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
5435 need_to_clear = 1;
5436 break;
5439 this_node_count = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
5440 - tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
5442 else
5443 this_node_count = 1;
5445 count += this_node_count;
5446 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
5447 zero_count += this_node_count;
5450 /* Clear the entire array first if there are any missing
5451 elements, or if the incidence of zero elements is >=
5452 75%. */
5453 if (! need_to_clear
5454 && (count < maxelt - minelt + 1
5455 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count))
5456 need_to_clear = 1;
5459 if (need_to_clear && size > 0)
5461 if (REG_P (target))
5462 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
5463 else
5464 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5465 cleared = 1;
5468 if (!cleared && REG_P (target))
5469 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
5470 emit_clobber (target);
5472 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
5473 corresponding element of TARGET, determined by counting the
5474 elements. */
5475 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i, index, value)
5477 enum machine_mode mode;
5478 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
5479 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
5480 rtx xtarget = target;
5482 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
5483 continue;
5485 mode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
5486 if (mode == BLKmode)
5487 bitsize = (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
5488 ? tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
5489 : -1);
5490 else
5491 bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
5493 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
5495 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
5496 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
5497 rtx index_r, pos_rtx;
5498 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi, count;
5499 tree position;
5501 /* If the range is constant and "small", unroll the loop. */
5502 if (const_bounds_p
5503 && host_integerp (lo_index, 0)
5504 && host_integerp (hi_index, 0)
5505 && (lo = tree_low_cst (lo_index, 0),
5506 hi = tree_low_cst (hi_index, 0),
5507 count = hi - lo + 1,
5508 (!MEM_P (target)
5509 || count <= 2
5510 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
5511 && (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1) * count
5512 <= 40 * 8)))))
5514 lo -= minelt; hi -= minelt;
5515 for (; lo <= hi; lo++)
5517 bitpos = lo * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 0);
5519 if (MEM_P (target)
5520 && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
5521 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
5522 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
5524 target = copy_rtx (target);
5525 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
5528 store_constructor_field
5529 (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value, type, cleared,
5530 get_alias_set (elttype));
5533 else
5535 rtx loop_start = gen_label_rtx ();
5536 rtx loop_end = gen_label_rtx ();
5537 tree exit_cond;
5539 expand_normal (hi_index);
5541 index = build_decl (EXPR_LOCATION (exp),
5542 VAR_DECL, NULL_TREE, domain);
5543 index_r = gen_reg_rtx (promote_decl_mode (index, NULL));
5544 SET_DECL_RTL (index, index_r);
5545 store_expr (lo_index, index_r, 0, false);
5547 /* Build the head of the loop. */
5548 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
5549 emit_label (loop_start);
5551 /* Assign value to element index. */
5552 position =
5553 fold_convert (ssizetype,
5554 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
5555 TREE_TYPE (index),
5556 index,
5557 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
5559 position =
5560 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, position,
5561 fold_convert (ssizetype,
5562 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
5564 pos_rtx = expand_normal (position);
5565 xtarget = offset_address (target, pos_rtx,
5566 highest_pow2_factor (position));
5567 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
5568 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5569 store_constructor (value, xtarget, cleared,
5570 bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5571 else
5572 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false);
5574 /* Generate a conditional jump to exit the loop. */
5575 exit_cond = build2 (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
5576 index, hi_index);
5577 jumpif (exit_cond, loop_end, -1);
5579 /* Update the loop counter, and jump to the head of
5580 the loop. */
5581 expand_assignment (index,
5582 build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
5583 index, integer_one_node),
5584 false);
5586 emit_jump (loop_start);
5588 /* Build the end of the loop. */
5589 emit_label (loop_end);
5592 else if ((index != 0 && ! host_integerp (index, 0))
5593 || ! host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1))
5595 tree position;
5597 if (index == 0)
5598 index = ssize_int (1);
5600 if (minelt)
5601 index = fold_convert (ssizetype,
5602 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
5603 TREE_TYPE (index),
5604 index,
5605 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
5607 position =
5608 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, index,
5609 fold_convert (ssizetype,
5610 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
5611 xtarget = offset_address (target,
5612 expand_normal (position),
5613 highest_pow2_factor (position));
5614 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
5615 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false);
5617 else
5619 if (index != 0)
5620 bitpos = ((tree_low_cst (index, 0) - minelt)
5621 * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
5622 else
5623 bitpos = (i * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
5625 if (MEM_P (target) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
5626 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
5627 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
5629 target = copy_rtx (target);
5630 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
5632 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value,
5633 type, cleared, get_alias_set (elttype));
5636 break;
5639 case VECTOR_TYPE:
5641 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5642 constructor_elt *ce;
5643 int i;
5644 int need_to_clear;
5645 int icode = 0;
5646 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
5647 int elt_size = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1);
5648 enum machine_mode eltmode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
5649 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
5650 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
5651 rtvec vector = NULL;
5652 unsigned n_elts;
5653 alias_set_type alias;
5655 gcc_assert (eltmode != BLKmode);
5657 n_elts = TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
5658 if (REG_P (target) && VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (target)))
5660 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (target);
5662 icode = (int) optab_handler (vec_init_optab, mode);
5663 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
5665 unsigned int i;
5667 vector = rtvec_alloc (n_elts);
5668 for (i = 0; i < n_elts; i++)
5669 RTVEC_ELT (vector, i) = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
5673 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the vector,
5674 clear the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
5675 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
5676 if (cleared)
5677 need_to_clear = 0;
5678 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
5679 need_to_clear = 1;
5680 else
5682 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
5683 tree value;
5685 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
5687 int n_elts_here = tree_low_cst
5688 (int_const_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
5689 TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)),
5690 TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 0), 1);
5692 count += n_elts_here;
5693 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
5694 zero_count += n_elts_here;
5697 /* Clear the entire vector first if there are any missing elements,
5698 or if the incidence of zero elements is >= 75%. */
5699 need_to_clear = (count < n_elts || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count);
5702 if (need_to_clear && size > 0 && !vector)
5704 if (REG_P (target))
5705 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
5706 else
5707 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5708 cleared = 1;
5711 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
5712 if (!cleared && !vector && REG_P (target))
5713 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
5715 if (MEM_P (target))
5716 alias = MEM_ALIAS_SET (target);
5717 else
5718 alias = get_alias_set (elttype);
5720 /* Store each element of the constructor into the corresponding
5721 element of TARGET, determined by counting the elements. */
5722 for (idx = 0, i = 0;
5723 VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce);
5724 idx++, i += bitsize / elt_size)
5726 HOST_WIDE_INT eltpos;
5727 tree value = ce->value;
5729 bitsize = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)), 1);
5730 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
5731 continue;
5733 if (ce->index)
5734 eltpos = tree_low_cst (ce->index, 1);
5735 else
5736 eltpos = i;
5738 if (vector)
5740 /* Vector CONSTRUCTORs should only be built from smaller
5741 vectors in the case of BLKmode vectors. */
5742 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) != VECTOR_TYPE);
5743 RTVEC_ELT (vector, eltpos)
5744 = expand_normal (value);
5746 else
5748 enum machine_mode value_mode =
5749 TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE
5750 ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (value))
5751 : eltmode;
5752 bitpos = eltpos * elt_size;
5753 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
5754 value_mode, value, type,
5755 cleared, alias);
5759 if (vector)
5760 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode)
5761 (target,
5762 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (target), vector)));
5763 break;
5766 default:
5767 gcc_unreachable ();
5771 /* Store the value of EXP (an expression tree)
5772 into a subfield of TARGET which has mode MODE and occupies
5773 BITSIZE bits, starting BITPOS bits from the start of TARGET.
5774 If MODE is VOIDmode, it means that we are storing into a bit-field.
5776 Always return const0_rtx unless we have something particular to
5777 return.
5779 TYPE is the type of the underlying object,
5781 ALIAS_SET is the alias set for the destination. This value will
5782 (in general) be different from that for TARGET, since TARGET is a
5783 reference to the containing structure.
5785 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
5787 static rtx
5788 store_field (rtx target, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
5789 enum machine_mode mode, tree exp, tree type,
5790 alias_set_type alias_set, bool nontemporal)
5792 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
5793 return const0_rtx;
5795 /* If we have nothing to store, do nothing unless the expression has
5796 side-effects. */
5797 if (bitsize == 0)
5798 return expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
5800 /* If we are storing into an unaligned field of an aligned union that is
5801 in a register, we may have the mode of TARGET being an integer mode but
5802 MODE == BLKmode. In that case, get an aligned object whose size and
5803 alignment are the same as TARGET and store TARGET into it (we can avoid
5804 the store if the field being stored is the entire width of TARGET). Then
5805 call ourselves recursively to store the field into a BLKmode version of
5806 that object. Finally, load from the object into TARGET. This is not
5807 very efficient in general, but should only be slightly more expensive
5808 than the otherwise-required unaligned accesses. Perhaps this can be
5809 cleaned up later. It's tempting to make OBJECT readonly, but it's set
5810 twice, once with emit_move_insn and once via store_field. */
5812 if (mode == BLKmode
5813 && (REG_P (target) || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG))
5815 rtx object = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
5816 rtx blk_object = adjust_address (object, BLKmode, 0);
5818 if (bitsize != (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (target)))
5819 emit_move_insn (object, target);
5821 store_field (blk_object, bitsize, bitpos, mode, exp, type, alias_set,
5822 nontemporal);
5824 emit_move_insn (target, object);
5826 /* We want to return the BLKmode version of the data. */
5827 return blk_object;
5830 if (GET_CODE (target) == CONCAT)
5832 /* We're storing into a struct containing a single __complex. */
5834 gcc_assert (!bitpos);
5835 return store_expr (exp, target, 0, nontemporal);
5838 /* If the structure is in a register or if the component
5839 is a bit field, we cannot use addressing to access it.
5840 Use bit-field techniques or SUBREG to store in it. */
5842 if (mode == VOIDmode
5843 || (mode != BLKmode && ! direct_store[(int) mode]
5844 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
5845 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
5846 || REG_P (target)
5847 || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG
5848 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to store as an ordinary memref,
5849 store it as a bit field. */
5850 || (mode != BLKmode
5851 && ((((MEM_ALIGN (target) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
5852 || bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
5853 && SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target)))
5854 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
5855 /* If the RHS and field are a constant size and the size of the
5856 RHS isn't the same size as the bitfield, we must use bitfield
5857 operations. */
5858 || (bitsize >= 0
5859 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
5860 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) != 0)
5861 /* If we are expanding a MEM_REF of a non-BLKmode non-addressable
5862 decl we must use bitfield operations. */
5863 || (bitsize >= 0
5864 && TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
5865 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
5866 && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
5867 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),0 ))
5868 && DECL_MODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)) != BLKmode))
5870 rtx temp;
5871 gimple nop_def;
5873 /* If EXP is a NOP_EXPR of precision less than its mode, then that
5874 implies a mask operation. If the precision is the same size as
5875 the field we're storing into, that mask is redundant. This is
5876 particularly common with bit field assignments generated by the
5877 C front end. */
5878 nop_def = get_def_for_expr (exp, NOP_EXPR);
5879 if (nop_def)
5881 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
5882 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
5883 && TYPE_PRECISION (type) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (type))
5884 && bitsize == TYPE_PRECISION (type))
5886 tree op = gimple_assign_rhs1 (nop_def);
5887 type = TREE_TYPE (op);
5888 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && TYPE_PRECISION (type) >= bitsize)
5889 exp = op;
5893 temp = expand_normal (exp);
5895 /* If BITSIZE is narrower than the size of the type of EXP
5896 we will be narrowing TEMP. Normally, what's wanted are the
5897 low-order bits. However, if EXP's type is a record and this is
5898 big-endian machine, we want the upper BITSIZE bits. */
5899 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (temp)) == MODE_INT
5900 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
5901 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == RECORD_TYPE)
5902 temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (temp), temp,
5903 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
5904 - bitsize),
5905 NULL_RTX, 1);
5907 /* Unless MODE is VOIDmode or BLKmode, convert TEMP to
5908 MODE. */
5909 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
5910 && mode != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5911 temp = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp, 1);
5913 /* If the modes of TEMP and TARGET are both BLKmode, both
5914 must be in memory and BITPOS must be aligned on a byte
5915 boundary. If so, we simply do a block copy. Likewise
5916 for a BLKmode-like TARGET. */
5917 if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode
5918 && (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
5919 || (MEM_P (target)
5920 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (target)) == MODE_INT
5921 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
5922 && (bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0)))
5924 gcc_assert (MEM_P (target) && MEM_P (temp)
5925 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
5927 target = adjust_address (target, VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5928 emit_block_move (target, temp,
5929 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
5930 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
5931 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5933 return const0_rtx;
5936 /* Store the value in the bitfield. */
5937 store_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, temp);
5939 return const0_rtx;
5941 else
5943 /* Now build a reference to just the desired component. */
5944 rtx to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5946 if (to_rtx == target)
5947 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
5949 MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (to_rtx, 1);
5950 if (!MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) && MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) != 0)
5951 set_mem_alias_set (to_rtx, alias_set);
5953 return store_expr (exp, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal);
5957 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, a BIT_FIELD_REF,
5958 an ARRAY_REF, or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for nested operations of these
5959 codes and find the ultimate containing object, which we return.
5961 We set *PBITSIZE to the size in bits that we want, *PBITPOS to the
5962 bit position, and *PUNSIGNEDP to the signedness of the field.
5963 If the position of the field is variable, we store a tree
5964 giving the variable offset (in units) in *POFFSET.
5965 This offset is in addition to the bit position.
5966 If the position is not variable, we store 0 in *POFFSET.
5968 If any of the extraction expressions is volatile,
5969 we store 1 in *PVOLATILEP. Otherwise we don't change that.
5971 If the field is a non-BLKmode bit-field, *PMODE is set to VOIDmode.
5972 Otherwise, it is a mode that can be used to access the field.
5974 If the field describes a variable-sized object, *PMODE is set to
5975 BLKmode and *PBITSIZE is set to -1. An access cannot be made in
5976 this case, but the address of the object can be found.
5978 If KEEP_ALIGNING is true and the target is STRICT_ALIGNMENT, we don't
5979 look through nodes that serve as markers of a greater alignment than
5980 the one that can be deduced from the expression. These nodes make it
5981 possible for front-ends to prevent temporaries from being created by
5982 the middle-end on alignment considerations. For that purpose, the
5983 normal operating mode at high-level is to always pass FALSE so that
5984 the ultimate containing object is really returned; moreover, the
5985 associated predicate handled_component_p will always return TRUE
5986 on these nodes, thus indicating that they are essentially handled
5987 by get_inner_reference. TRUE should only be passed when the caller
5988 is scanning the expression in order to build another representation
5989 and specifically knows how to handle these nodes; as such, this is
5990 the normal operating mode in the RTL expanders. */
5992 tree
5993 get_inner_reference (tree exp, HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitsize,
5994 HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitpos, tree *poffset,
5995 enum machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp,
5996 int *pvolatilep, bool keep_aligning)
5998 tree size_tree = 0;
5999 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
6000 bool blkmode_bitfield = false;
6001 tree offset = size_zero_node;
6002 double_int bit_offset = double_int_zero;
6004 /* First get the mode, signedness, and size. We do this from just the
6005 outermost expression. */
6006 *pbitsize = -1;
6007 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
6009 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6010 size_tree = DECL_SIZE (field);
6011 if (!DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
6012 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
6013 else if (DECL_MODE (field) == BLKmode)
6014 blkmode_bitfield = true;
6015 else if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
6016 && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
6017 /* Volatile bitfields should be accessed in the mode of the
6018 field's type, not the mode computed based on the bit
6019 size. */
6020 mode = TYPE_MODE (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field));
6022 *punsignedp = DECL_UNSIGNED (field);
6024 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
6026 size_tree = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6027 *punsignedp = (! INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6028 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6030 /* For vector types, with the correct size of access, use the mode of
6031 inner type. */
6032 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == VECTOR_TYPE
6033 && TREE_TYPE (exp) == TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
6034 && tree_int_cst_equal (size_tree, TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))))
6035 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6037 else
6039 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6040 *punsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6042 if (mode == BLKmode)
6043 size_tree = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6044 else
6045 *pbitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
6048 if (size_tree != 0)
6050 if (! host_integerp (size_tree, 1))
6051 mode = BLKmode, *pbitsize = -1;
6052 else
6053 *pbitsize = tree_low_cst (size_tree, 1);
6056 /* Compute cumulative bit-offset for nested component-refs and array-refs,
6057 and find the ultimate containing object. */
6058 while (1)
6060 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6062 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6063 bit_offset
6064 = double_int_add (bit_offset,
6065 tree_to_double_int (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)));
6066 break;
6068 case COMPONENT_REF:
6070 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6071 tree this_offset = component_ref_field_offset (exp);
6073 /* If this field hasn't been filled in yet, don't go past it.
6074 This should only happen when folding expressions made during
6075 type construction. */
6076 if (this_offset == 0)
6077 break;
6079 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset, this_offset);
6080 bit_offset = double_int_add (bit_offset,
6081 tree_to_double_int
6082 (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field)));
6084 /* ??? Right now we don't do anything with DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN. */
6086 break;
6088 case ARRAY_REF:
6089 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6091 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6092 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
6093 tree unit_size = array_ref_element_size (exp);
6095 /* We assume all arrays have sizes that are a multiple of a byte.
6096 First subtract the lower bound, if any, in the type of the
6097 index, then convert to sizetype and multiply by the size of
6098 the array element. */
6099 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
6100 index = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
6101 index, low_bound);
6103 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
6104 size_binop (MULT_EXPR,
6105 fold_convert (sizetype, index),
6106 unit_size));
6108 break;
6110 case REALPART_EXPR:
6111 break;
6113 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
6114 bit_offset = double_int_add (bit_offset,
6115 uhwi_to_double_int (*pbitsize));
6116 break;
6118 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
6119 if (keep_aligning && STRICT_ALIGNMENT
6120 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6121 > TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
6122 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
6123 < BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
6124 && (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6125 || TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
6126 goto done;
6127 break;
6129 case MEM_REF:
6130 /* Hand back the decl for MEM[&decl, off]. */
6131 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR)
6133 tree off = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6134 if (!integer_zerop (off))
6136 double_int boff, coff = mem_ref_offset (exp);
6137 boff = double_int_lshift (coff,
6138 BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6139 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT),
6140 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT, true);
6141 bit_offset = double_int_add (bit_offset, boff);
6143 exp = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
6145 goto done;
6147 default:
6148 goto done;
6151 /* If any reference in the chain is volatile, the effect is volatile. */
6152 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
6153 *pvolatilep = 1;
6155 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6157 done:
6159 /* If OFFSET is constant, see if we can return the whole thing as a
6160 constant bit position. Make sure to handle overflow during
6161 this conversion. */
6162 if (host_integerp (offset, 0))
6164 double_int tem = double_int_lshift (tree_to_double_int (offset),
6165 BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6166 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT),
6167 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT, true);
6168 tem = double_int_add (tem, bit_offset);
6169 if (double_int_fits_in_shwi_p (tem))
6171 *pbitpos = double_int_to_shwi (tem);
6172 *poffset = offset = NULL_TREE;
6176 /* Otherwise, split it up. */
6177 if (offset)
6179 *pbitpos = double_int_to_shwi (bit_offset);
6180 *poffset = offset;
6183 /* We can use BLKmode for a byte-aligned BLKmode bitfield. */
6184 if (mode == VOIDmode
6185 && blkmode_bitfield
6186 && (*pbitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
6187 && (*pbitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0)
6188 *pmode = BLKmode;
6189 else
6190 *pmode = mode;
6192 return exp;
6195 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, an ARRAY_REF or an
6196 ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for whether EXP or any nested component-refs within
6197 EXP is marked as PACKED. */
6199 bool
6200 contains_packed_reference (const_tree exp)
6202 bool packed_p = false;
6204 while (1)
6206 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6208 case COMPONENT_REF:
6210 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6211 packed_p = DECL_PACKED (field)
6212 || TYPE_PACKED (TREE_TYPE (field))
6213 || TYPE_PACKED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6214 if (packed_p)
6215 goto done;
6217 break;
6219 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6220 case ARRAY_REF:
6221 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6222 case REALPART_EXPR:
6223 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
6224 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
6225 break;
6227 default:
6228 goto done;
6230 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6232 done:
6233 return packed_p;
6236 /* Return a tree of sizetype representing the size, in bytes, of the element
6237 of EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6239 tree
6240 array_ref_element_size (tree exp)
6242 tree aligned_size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 3);
6243 tree elmt_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6244 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
6246 /* If a size was specified in the ARRAY_REF, it's the size measured
6247 in alignment units of the element type. So multiply by that value. */
6248 if (aligned_size)
6250 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
6251 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
6252 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_size) != sizetype)
6253 aligned_size = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, aligned_size);
6254 return size_binop_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, aligned_size,
6255 size_int (TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (elmt_type)));
6258 /* Otherwise, take the size from that of the element type. Substitute
6259 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
6260 else
6261 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elmt_type), exp);
6264 /* Return a tree representing the lower bound of the array mentioned in
6265 EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6267 tree
6268 array_ref_low_bound (tree exp)
6270 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6272 /* If a lower bound is specified in EXP, use it. */
6273 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))
6274 return TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
6276 /* Otherwise, if there is a domain type and it has a lower bound, use it,
6277 substituting for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
6278 if (domain_type && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type))
6279 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
6281 /* Otherwise, return a zero of the appropriate type. */
6282 return build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)), 0);
6285 /* Return a tree representing the upper bound of the array mentioned in
6286 EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6288 tree
6289 array_ref_up_bound (tree exp)
6291 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6293 /* If there is a domain type and it has an upper bound, use it, substituting
6294 for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
6295 if (domain_type && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type))
6296 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
6298 /* Otherwise fail. */
6299 return NULL_TREE;
6302 /* Return a tree representing the offset, in bytes, of the field referenced
6303 by EXP. This does not include any offset in DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET. */
6305 tree
6306 component_ref_field_offset (tree exp)
6308 tree aligned_offset = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
6309 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6310 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
6312 /* If an offset was specified in the COMPONENT_REF, it's the offset measured
6313 in units of DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN / BITS_PER_UNIT. So multiply by that
6314 value. */
6315 if (aligned_offset)
6317 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
6318 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
6319 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_offset) != sizetype)
6320 aligned_offset = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, aligned_offset);
6321 return size_binop_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, aligned_offset,
6322 size_int (DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN (field)
6323 / BITS_PER_UNIT));
6326 /* Otherwise, take the offset from that of the field. Substitute
6327 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
6328 else
6329 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), exp);
6332 /* Alignment in bits the TARGET of an assignment may be assumed to have. */
6334 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
6335 target_align (const_tree target)
6337 /* We might have a chain of nested references with intermediate misaligning
6338 bitfields components, so need to recurse to find out. */
6340 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT this_align, outer_align;
6342 switch (TREE_CODE (target))
6344 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6345 return 1;
6347 case COMPONENT_REF:
6348 this_align = DECL_ALIGN (TREE_OPERAND (target, 1));
6349 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6350 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
6352 case ARRAY_REF:
6353 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6354 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6355 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6356 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
6358 CASE_CONVERT:
6359 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
6360 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
6361 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6362 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6363 return MAX (this_align, outer_align);
6365 default:
6366 return TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6371 /* Given an rtx VALUE that may contain additions and multiplications, return
6372 an equivalent value that just refers to a register, memory, or constant.
6373 This is done by generating instructions to perform the arithmetic and
6374 returning a pseudo-register containing the value.
6376 The returned value may be a REG, SUBREG, MEM or constant. */
6379 force_operand (rtx value, rtx target)
6381 rtx op1, op2;
6382 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
6383 rtx subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
6384 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (value);
6386 /* Check for subreg applied to an expression produced by loop optimizer. */
6387 if (code == SUBREG
6388 && !REG_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
6389 && !MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
6391 value
6392 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
6393 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6394 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
6395 NULL_RTX)),
6396 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6397 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
6398 code = GET_CODE (value);
6401 /* Check for a PIC address load. */
6402 if ((code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
6403 && XEXP (value, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
6404 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF
6405 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == LABEL_REF
6406 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == CONST))
6408 if (!subtarget)
6409 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
6410 emit_move_insn (subtarget, value);
6411 return subtarget;
6414 if (ARITHMETIC_P (value))
6416 op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
6417 if (!CONSTANT_P (op2) && !(REG_P (op2) && op2 != subtarget))
6418 subtarget = 0;
6419 if (code == MINUS && CONST_INT_P (op2))
6421 code = PLUS;
6422 op2 = negate_rtx (GET_MODE (value), op2);
6425 /* Check for an addition with OP2 a constant integer and our first
6426 operand a PLUS of a virtual register and something else. In that
6427 case, we want to emit the sum of the virtual register and the
6428 constant first and then add the other value. This allows virtual
6429 register instantiation to simply modify the constant rather than
6430 creating another one around this addition. */
6431 if (code == PLUS && CONST_INT_P (op2)
6432 && GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 0)) == PLUS
6433 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0))
6434 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
6435 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
6437 rtx temp = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code,
6438 XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0), op2,
6439 subtarget, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6440 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, temp,
6441 force_operand (XEXP (XEXP (value,
6442 0), 1), 0),
6443 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6446 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
6447 op2 = force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX);
6448 switch (code)
6450 case MULT:
6451 return expand_mult (GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 1);
6452 case DIV:
6453 if (!INTEGRAL_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value)))
6454 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
6455 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6456 else
6457 return expand_divmod (0,
6458 FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value))
6459 ? RDIV_EXPR : TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
6460 GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 0);
6461 case MOD:
6462 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
6463 target, 0);
6464 case UDIV:
6465 return expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
6466 target, 1);
6467 case UMOD:
6468 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
6469 target, 1);
6470 case ASHIFTRT:
6471 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
6472 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6473 default:
6474 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
6475 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6478 if (UNARY_P (value))
6480 if (!target)
6481 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
6482 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL_RTX);
6483 switch (code)
6485 case ZERO_EXTEND:
6486 case SIGN_EXTEND:
6487 case TRUNCATE:
6488 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
6489 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
6490 convert_move (target, op1, code == ZERO_EXTEND);
6491 return target;
6493 case FIX:
6494 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
6495 expand_fix (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FIX);
6496 return target;
6498 case FLOAT:
6499 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
6500 expand_float (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
6501 return target;
6503 default:
6504 return expand_simple_unop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, target, 0);
6508 #ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
6509 /* On machines that have insn scheduling, we want all memory reference to be
6510 explicit, so we need to deal with such paradoxical SUBREGs. */
6511 if (GET_CODE (value) == SUBREG && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
6512 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (value))
6513 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)))))
6514 value
6515 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
6516 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6517 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
6518 NULL_RTX)),
6519 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6520 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
6521 #endif
6523 return value;
6526 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return nonzero iff there is no way that
6527 EXP can reference X, which is being modified. TOP_P is nonzero if this
6528 call is going to be used to determine whether we need a temporary
6529 for EXP, as opposed to a recursive call to this function.
6531 It is always safe for this routine to return zero since it merely
6532 searches for optimization opportunities. */
6535 safe_from_p (const_rtx x, tree exp, int top_p)
6537 rtx exp_rtl = 0;
6538 int i, nops;
6540 if (x == 0
6541 /* If EXP has varying size, we MUST use a target since we currently
6542 have no way of allocating temporaries of variable size
6543 (except for arrays that have TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE set).
6544 So we assume here that something at a higher level has prevented a
6545 clash. This is somewhat bogus, but the best we can do. Only
6546 do this when X is BLKmode and when we are at the top level. */
6547 || (top_p && TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6548 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != INTEGER_CST
6549 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != ARRAY_TYPE
6550 || TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == NULL_TREE
6551 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
6552 != INTEGER_CST)
6553 && GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode)
6554 /* If X is in the outgoing argument area, it is always safe. */
6555 || (MEM_P (x)
6556 && (XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx
6557 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
6558 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx))))
6559 return 1;
6561 /* If this is a subreg of a hard register, declare it unsafe, otherwise,
6562 find the underlying pseudo. */
6563 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
6565 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
6566 if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6567 return 0;
6570 /* Now look at our tree code and possibly recurse. */
6571 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)))
6573 case tcc_declaration:
6574 exp_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (exp);
6575 break;
6577 case tcc_constant:
6578 return 1;
6580 case tcc_exceptional:
6581 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TREE_LIST)
6583 while (1)
6585 if (TREE_VALUE (exp) && !safe_from_p (x, TREE_VALUE (exp), 0))
6586 return 0;
6587 exp = TREE_CHAIN (exp);
6588 if (!exp)
6589 return 1;
6590 if (TREE_CODE (exp) != TREE_LIST)
6591 return safe_from_p (x, exp, 0);
6594 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
6596 constructor_elt *ce;
6597 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
6599 for (idx = 0;
6600 VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce);
6601 idx++)
6602 if ((ce->index != NULL_TREE && !safe_from_p (x, ce->index, 0))
6603 || !safe_from_p (x, ce->value, 0))
6604 return 0;
6605 return 1;
6607 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
6608 return 1; /* An already-visited SAVE_EXPR? */
6609 else
6610 return 0;
6612 case tcc_statement:
6613 /* The only case we look at here is the DECL_INITIAL inside a
6614 DECL_EXPR. */
6615 return (TREE_CODE (exp) != DECL_EXPR
6616 || TREE_CODE (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)) != VAR_DECL
6617 || !DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp))
6618 || safe_from_p (x, DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)), 0));
6620 case tcc_binary:
6621 case tcc_comparison:
6622 if (!safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
6623 return 0;
6624 /* Fall through. */
6626 case tcc_unary:
6627 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
6629 case tcc_expression:
6630 case tcc_reference:
6631 case tcc_vl_exp:
6632 /* Now do code-specific tests. EXP_RTL is set to any rtx we find in
6633 the expression. If it is set, we conflict iff we are that rtx or
6634 both are in memory. Otherwise, we check all operands of the
6635 expression recursively. */
6637 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6639 case ADDR_EXPR:
6640 /* If the operand is static or we are static, we can't conflict.
6641 Likewise if we don't conflict with the operand at all. */
6642 if (staticp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
6643 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
6644 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
6645 return 1;
6647 /* Otherwise, the only way this can conflict is if we are taking
6648 the address of a DECL a that address if part of X, which is
6649 very rare. */
6650 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6651 if (DECL_P (exp))
6653 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (exp)
6654 || !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (exp)))
6655 return 0;
6656 else
6657 exp_rtl = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
6659 break;
6661 case MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF:
6662 case INDIRECT_REF:
6663 if (MEM_P (x)
6664 && alias_sets_conflict_p (MEM_ALIAS_SET (x),
6665 get_alias_set (exp)))
6666 return 0;
6667 break;
6669 case CALL_EXPR:
6670 /* Assume that the call will clobber all hard registers and
6671 all of memory. */
6672 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6673 || MEM_P (x))
6674 return 0;
6675 break;
6677 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
6678 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
6679 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
6680 gcc_unreachable ();
6682 case SAVE_EXPR:
6683 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
6685 default:
6686 break;
6689 /* If we have an rtx, we do not need to scan our operands. */
6690 if (exp_rtl)
6691 break;
6693 nops = TREE_OPERAND_LENGTH (exp);
6694 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
6695 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0
6696 && ! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, i), 0))
6697 return 0;
6699 break;
6701 case tcc_type:
6702 /* Should never get a type here. */
6703 gcc_unreachable ();
6706 /* If we have an rtl, find any enclosed object. Then see if we conflict
6707 with it. */
6708 if (exp_rtl)
6710 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == SUBREG)
6712 exp_rtl = SUBREG_REG (exp_rtl);
6713 if (REG_P (exp_rtl)
6714 && REGNO (exp_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6715 return 0;
6718 /* If the rtl is X, then it is not safe. Otherwise, it is unless both
6719 are memory and they conflict. */
6720 return ! (rtx_equal_p (x, exp_rtl)
6721 || (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (exp_rtl)
6722 && true_dependence (exp_rtl, VOIDmode, x,
6723 rtx_addr_varies_p)));
6726 /* If we reach here, it is safe. */
6727 return 1;
6731 /* Return the highest power of two that EXP is known to be a multiple of.
6732 This is used in updating alignment of MEMs in array references. */
6734 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
6735 highest_pow2_factor (const_tree exp)
6737 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c0, c1;
6739 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6741 case INTEGER_CST:
6742 /* We can find the lowest bit that's a one. If the low
6743 HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT bits are zero, return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT.
6744 We need to handle this case since we can find it in a COND_EXPR,
6745 a MIN_EXPR, or a MAX_EXPR. If the constant overflows, we have an
6746 erroneous program, so return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT to avoid any
6747 later ICE. */
6748 if (TREE_OVERFLOW (exp))
6749 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
6750 else
6752 /* Note: tree_low_cst is intentionally not used here,
6753 we don't care about the upper bits. */
6754 c0 = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp);
6755 c0 &= -c0;
6756 return c0 ? c0 : BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
6758 break;
6760 case PLUS_EXPR: case MINUS_EXPR: case MIN_EXPR: case MAX_EXPR:
6761 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6762 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
6763 return MIN (c0, c1);
6765 case MULT_EXPR:
6766 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6767 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
6768 return c0 * c1;
6770 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR: case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR: case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
6771 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
6772 if (integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
6773 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
6775 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6776 c1 = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1);
6777 return MAX (1, c0 / c1);
6779 break;
6781 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
6782 /* The highest power of two of a bit-and expression is the maximum of
6783 that of its operands. We typically get here for a complex LHS and
6784 a constant negative power of two on the RHS to force an explicit
6785 alignment, so don't bother looking at the LHS. */
6786 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
6788 CASE_CONVERT:
6789 case SAVE_EXPR:
6790 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6792 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
6793 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
6795 case COND_EXPR:
6796 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
6797 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
6798 return MIN (c0, c1);
6800 default:
6801 break;
6804 return 1;
6807 /* Similar, except that the alignment requirements of TARGET are
6808 taken into account. Assume it is at least as aligned as its
6809 type, unless it is a COMPONENT_REF in which case the layout of
6810 the structure gives the alignment. */
6812 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
6813 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree target, const_tree exp)
6815 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT talign = target_align (target) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
6816 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT factor = highest_pow2_factor (exp);
6818 return MAX (factor, talign);
6821 /* Return &VAR expression for emulated thread local VAR. */
6823 static tree
6824 emutls_var_address (tree var)
6826 tree emuvar = emutls_decl (var);
6827 tree fn = built_in_decls [BUILT_IN_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS];
6828 tree arg = build_fold_addr_expr_with_type (emuvar, ptr_type_node);
6829 tree call = build_call_expr (fn, 1, arg);
6830 return fold_convert (build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (var)), call);
6834 /* Subroutine of expand_expr. Expand the two operands of a binary
6835 expression EXP0 and EXP1 placing the results in OP0 and OP1.
6836 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero. The
6837 MODIFIER argument is as documented by expand_expr. */
6839 static void
6840 expand_operands (tree exp0, tree exp1, rtx target, rtx *op0, rtx *op1,
6841 enum expand_modifier modifier)
6843 if (! safe_from_p (target, exp1, 1))
6844 target = 0;
6845 if (operand_equal_p (exp0, exp1, 0))
6847 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
6848 *op1 = copy_rtx (*op0);
6850 else
6852 /* If we need to preserve evaluation order, copy exp0 into its own
6853 temporary variable so that it can't be clobbered by exp1. */
6854 if (flag_evaluation_order && TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp1))
6855 exp0 = save_expr (exp0);
6856 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
6857 *op1 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
6862 /* Return a MEM that contains constant EXP. DEFER is as for
6863 output_constant_def and MODIFIER is as for expand_expr. */
6865 static rtx
6866 expand_expr_constant (tree exp, int defer, enum expand_modifier modifier)
6868 rtx mem;
6870 mem = output_constant_def (exp, defer);
6871 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
6872 mem = use_anchored_address (mem);
6873 return mem;
6876 /* A subroutine of expand_expr_addr_expr. Evaluate the address of EXP.
6877 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
6879 static rtx
6880 expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
6881 enum expand_modifier modifier, addr_space_t as)
6883 rtx result, subtarget;
6884 tree inner, offset;
6885 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
6886 int volatilep, unsignedp;
6887 enum machine_mode mode1;
6889 /* If we are taking the address of a constant and are at the top level,
6890 we have to use output_constant_def since we can't call force_const_mem
6891 at top level. */
6892 /* ??? This should be considered a front-end bug. We should not be
6893 generating ADDR_EXPR of something that isn't an LVALUE. The only
6894 exception here is STRING_CST. */
6895 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (exp))
6896 return XEXP (expand_expr_constant (exp, 0, modifier), 0);
6898 /* Everything must be something allowed by is_gimple_addressable. */
6899 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6901 case INDIRECT_REF:
6902 /* This case will happen via recursion for &a->b. */
6903 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
6905 case MEM_REF:
6907 tree tem = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6908 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
6909 tem = build2 (POINTER_PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)),
6910 tem,
6911 double_int_to_tree (sizetype, mem_ref_offset (exp)));
6912 return expand_expr (tem, target, tmode, modifier);
6915 case CONST_DECL:
6916 /* Expand the initializer like constants above. */
6917 return XEXP (expand_expr_constant (DECL_INITIAL (exp), 0, modifier), 0);
6919 case REALPART_EXPR:
6920 /* The real part of the complex number is always first, therefore
6921 the address is the same as the address of the parent object. */
6922 offset = 0;
6923 bitpos = 0;
6924 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6925 break;
6927 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
6928 /* The imaginary part of the complex number is always second.
6929 The expression is therefore always offset by the size of the
6930 scalar type. */
6931 offset = 0;
6932 bitpos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6933 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6934 break;
6936 case VAR_DECL:
6937 /* TLS emulation hook - replace __thread VAR's &VAR with
6938 __emutls_get_address (&_emutls.VAR). */
6939 if (! targetm.have_tls
6940 && TREE_CODE (exp) == VAR_DECL
6941 && DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (exp))
6943 exp = emutls_var_address (exp);
6944 return expand_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
6946 /* Fall through. */
6948 default:
6949 /* If the object is a DECL, then expand it for its rtl. Don't bypass
6950 expand_expr, as that can have various side effects; LABEL_DECLs for
6951 example, may not have their DECL_RTL set yet. Expand the rtl of
6952 CONSTRUCTORs too, which should yield a memory reference for the
6953 constructor's contents. Assume language specific tree nodes can
6954 be expanded in some interesting way. */
6955 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) < LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE);
6956 if (DECL_P (exp)
6957 || TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
6958 || TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR)
6960 result = expand_expr (exp, target, tmode,
6961 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6962 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
6964 /* If the DECL isn't in memory, then the DECL wasn't properly
6965 marked TREE_ADDRESSABLE, which will be either a front-end
6966 or a tree optimizer bug. */
6967 gcc_assert (MEM_P (result));
6968 result = XEXP (result, 0);
6970 /* ??? Is this needed anymore? */
6971 if (DECL_P (exp) && !TREE_USED (exp) == 0)
6973 assemble_external (exp);
6974 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
6977 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6978 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
6979 result = force_operand (result, target);
6980 return result;
6983 /* Pass FALSE as the last argument to get_inner_reference although
6984 we are expanding to RTL. The rationale is that we know how to
6985 handle "aligning nodes" here: we can just bypass them because
6986 they won't change the final object whose address will be returned
6987 (they actually exist only for that purpose). */
6988 inner = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
6989 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
6990 break;
6993 /* We must have made progress. */
6994 gcc_assert (inner != exp);
6996 subtarget = offset || bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
6997 /* For VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, where the outer alignment is bigger than
6998 inner alignment, force the inner to be sufficiently aligned. */
6999 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (inner)
7000 && TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) < TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7002 inner = copy_node (inner);
7003 TREE_TYPE (inner) = copy_node (TREE_TYPE (inner));
7004 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7005 TYPE_USER_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = 1;
7007 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (inner, subtarget, tmode, modifier, as);
7009 if (offset)
7011 rtx tmp;
7013 if (modifier != EXPAND_NORMAL)
7014 result = force_operand (result, NULL);
7015 tmp = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, tmode,
7016 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7017 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_NORMAL);
7019 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7020 tmp = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, tmp, as);
7022 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7023 result = gen_rtx_PLUS (tmode, result, tmp);
7024 else
7026 subtarget = bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
7027 result = expand_simple_binop (tmode, PLUS, result, tmp, subtarget,
7028 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7032 if (bitpos)
7034 /* Someone beforehand should have rejected taking the address
7035 of such an object. */
7036 gcc_assert ((bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
7038 result = plus_constant (result, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7039 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7040 result = force_operand (result, target);
7043 return result;
7046 /* A subroutine of expand_expr. Evaluate EXP, which is an ADDR_EXPR.
7047 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
7049 static rtx
7050 expand_expr_addr_expr (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7051 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7053 addr_space_t as = ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC;
7054 enum machine_mode address_mode = Pmode;
7055 enum machine_mode pointer_mode = ptr_mode;
7056 enum machine_mode rmode;
7057 rtx result;
7059 /* Target mode of VOIDmode says "whatever's natural". */
7060 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
7061 tmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7063 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7065 as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
7066 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
7067 pointer_mode = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (as);
7070 /* We can get called with some Weird Things if the user does silliness
7071 like "(short) &a". In that case, convert_memory_address won't do
7072 the right thing, so ignore the given target mode. */
7073 if (tmode != address_mode && tmode != pointer_mode)
7074 tmode = address_mode;
7076 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target,
7077 tmode, modifier, as);
7079 /* Despite expand_expr claims concerning ignoring TMODE when not
7080 strictly convenient, stuff breaks if we don't honor it. Note
7081 that combined with the above, we only do this for pointer modes. */
7082 rmode = GET_MODE (result);
7083 if (rmode == VOIDmode)
7084 rmode = tmode;
7085 if (rmode != tmode)
7086 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7088 return result;
7091 /* Generate code for computing CONSTRUCTOR EXP.
7092 An rtx for the computed value is returned. If AVOID_TEMP_MEM
7093 is TRUE, instead of creating a temporary variable in memory
7094 NULL is returned and the caller needs to handle it differently. */
7096 static rtx
7097 expand_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, enum expand_modifier modifier,
7098 bool avoid_temp_mem)
7100 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
7101 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7103 /* Try to avoid creating a temporary at all. This is possible
7104 if all of the initializer is zero.
7105 FIXME: try to handle all [0..255] initializers we can handle
7106 with memset. */
7107 if (TREE_STATIC (exp)
7108 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7109 && target != 0 && mode == BLKmode
7110 && all_zeros_p (exp))
7112 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
7113 return target;
7116 /* All elts simple constants => refer to a constant in memory. But
7117 if this is a non-BLKmode mode, let it store a field at a time
7118 since that should make a CONST_INT or CONST_DOUBLE when we
7119 fold. Likewise, if we have a target we can use, it is best to
7120 store directly into the target unless the type is large enough
7121 that memcpy will be used. If we are making an initializer and
7122 all operands are constant, put it in memory as well.
7124 FIXME: Avoid trying to fill vector constructors piece-meal.
7125 Output them with output_constant_def below unless we're sure
7126 they're zeros. This should go away when vector initializers
7127 are treated like VECTOR_CST instead of arrays. */
7128 if ((TREE_STATIC (exp)
7129 && ((mode == BLKmode
7130 && ! (target != 0 && safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)))
7131 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7132 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1)
7133 && (! MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
7134 (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1),
7135 TYPE_ALIGN (type)))
7136 && ! mostly_zeros_p (exp))))
7137 || ((modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
7138 && TREE_CONSTANT (exp)))
7140 rtx constructor;
7142 if (avoid_temp_mem)
7143 return NULL_RTX;
7145 constructor = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
7147 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7148 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7149 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
7150 constructor = validize_mem (constructor);
7152 return constructor;
7155 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
7156 locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
7157 if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
7158 || GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7160 if (avoid_temp_mem)
7161 return NULL_RTX;
7163 target
7164 = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type, (TYPE_QUALS (type)
7165 | (TREE_READONLY (exp)
7166 * TYPE_QUAL_CONST))),
7167 0, TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp), 1);
7170 store_constructor (exp, target, 0, int_expr_size (exp));
7171 return target;
7175 /* expand_expr: generate code for computing expression EXP.
7176 An rtx for the computed value is returned. The value is never null.
7177 In the case of a void EXP, const0_rtx is returned.
7179 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero.
7180 TARGET is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
7181 the rtx returned may not be the same as TARGET.
7183 If TARGET is CONST0_RTX, it means that the value will be ignored.
7185 If TMODE is not VOIDmode, it suggests generating the
7186 result in mode TMODE. But this is done only when convenient.
7187 Otherwise, TMODE is ignored and the value generated in its natural mode.
7188 TMODE is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
7189 the rtx returned may not have mode TMODE.
7191 Note that TARGET may have neither TMODE nor MODE. In that case, it
7192 probably will not be used.
7194 If MODIFIER is EXPAND_SUM then when EXP is an addition
7195 we can return an rtx of the form (MULT (REG ...) (CONST_INT ...))
7196 or a nest of (PLUS ...) and (MINUS ...) where the terms are
7197 products as above, or REG or MEM, or constant.
7198 Ordinarily in such cases we would output mul or add instructions
7199 and then return a pseudo reg containing the sum.
7201 EXPAND_INITIALIZER is much like EXPAND_SUM except that
7202 it also marks a label as absolutely required (it can't be dead).
7203 It also makes a ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND instead of emitting extend insns.
7204 This is used for outputting expressions used in initializers.
7206 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS says that it is okay to return a MEM
7207 with a constant address even if that address is not normally legitimate.
7208 EXPAND_INITIALIZER and EXPAND_SUM also have this effect.
7210 EXPAND_STACK_PARM is used when expanding to a TARGET on the stack for
7211 a call parameter. Such targets require special care as we haven't yet
7212 marked TARGET so that it's safe from being trashed by libcalls. We
7213 don't want to use TARGET for anything but the final result;
7214 Intermediate values must go elsewhere. Additionally, calls to
7215 emit_block_move will be flagged with BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM.
7217 If EXP is a VAR_DECL whose DECL_RTL was a MEM with an invalid
7218 address, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL, then *ALT_RTL is set to the
7219 DECL_RTL of the VAR_DECL. *ALT_RTL is also set if EXP is a
7220 COMPOUND_EXPR whose second argument is such a VAR_DECL, and so on
7221 recursively. */
7224 expand_expr_real (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7225 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
7227 rtx ret;
7229 /* Handle ERROR_MARK before anybody tries to access its type. */
7230 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK
7231 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == ERROR_MARK))
7233 ret = CONST0_RTX (tmode);
7234 return ret ? ret : const0_rtx;
7237 /* If this is an expression of some kind and it has an associated line
7238 number, then emit the line number before expanding the expression.
7240 We need to save and restore the file and line information so that
7241 errors discovered during expansion are emitted with the right
7242 information. It would be better of the diagnostic routines
7243 used the file/line information embedded in the tree nodes rather
7244 than globals. */
7245 if (cfun && EXPR_HAS_LOCATION (exp))
7247 location_t saved_location = input_location;
7248 location_t saved_curr_loc = get_curr_insn_source_location ();
7249 tree saved_block = get_curr_insn_block ();
7250 input_location = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
7251 set_curr_insn_source_location (input_location);
7253 /* Record where the insns produced belong. */
7254 set_curr_insn_block (TREE_BLOCK (exp));
7256 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
7258 input_location = saved_location;
7259 set_curr_insn_block (saved_block);
7260 set_curr_insn_source_location (saved_curr_loc);
7262 else
7264 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
7267 return ret;
7271 expand_expr_real_2 (sepops ops, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7272 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7274 rtx op0, op1, op2, temp;
7275 tree type;
7276 int unsignedp;
7277 enum machine_mode mode;
7278 enum tree_code code = ops->code;
7279 optab this_optab;
7280 rtx subtarget, original_target;
7281 int ignore;
7282 bool reduce_bit_field;
7283 location_t loc = ops->location;
7284 tree treeop0, treeop1;
7285 #define REDUCE_BIT_FIELD(expr) (reduce_bit_field \
7286 ? reduce_to_bit_field_precision ((expr), \
7287 target, \
7288 type) \
7289 : (expr))
7291 type = ops->type;
7292 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7293 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
7295 treeop0 = ops->op0;
7296 treeop1 = ops->op1;
7298 /* We should be called only on simple (binary or unary) expressions,
7299 exactly those that are valid in gimple expressions that aren't
7300 GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS (or invalid). */
7301 gcc_assert (get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS
7302 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS
7303 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS);
7305 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
7306 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
7307 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
7308 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
7310 /* We should be called only if we need the result. */
7311 gcc_assert (!ignore);
7313 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
7314 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
7315 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
7316 reduce_bit_field = (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE
7317 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type));
7319 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7320 target = 0;
7322 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
7323 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
7324 original_target = target;
7326 switch (code)
7328 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
7329 case PAREN_EXPR:
7330 CASE_CONVERT:
7331 if (treeop0 == error_mark_node)
7332 return const0_rtx;
7334 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
7336 tree valtype = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
7338 /* If both input and output are BLKmode, this conversion isn't doing
7339 anything except possibly changing memory attribute. */
7340 if (mode == BLKmode && TYPE_MODE (valtype) == BLKmode)
7342 rtx result = expand_expr (treeop0, target, tmode,
7343 modifier);
7345 result = copy_rtx (result);
7346 set_mem_attributes (result, type, 0);
7347 return result;
7350 if (target == 0)
7352 if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode)
7353 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
7354 else
7355 target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
7358 if (MEM_P (target))
7359 /* Store data into beginning of memory target. */
7360 store_expr (treeop0,
7361 adjust_address (target, TYPE_MODE (valtype), 0),
7362 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
7363 false);
7365 else
7367 gcc_assert (REG_P (target));
7369 /* Store this field into a union of the proper type. */
7370 store_field (target,
7371 MIN ((int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE
7372 (treeop0))
7373 * BITS_PER_UNIT),
7374 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)),
7375 0, TYPE_MODE (valtype), treeop0,
7376 type, 0, false);
7379 /* Return the entire union. */
7380 return target;
7383 if (mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
7385 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, target, VOIDmode,
7386 modifier);
7388 /* If the signedness of the conversion differs and OP0 is
7389 a promoted SUBREG, clear that indication since we now
7390 have to do the proper extension. */
7391 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != unsignedp
7392 && GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
7393 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0) = 0;
7395 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
7398 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, mode,
7399 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier);
7400 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
7403 /* If OP0 is a constant, just convert it into the proper mode. */
7404 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
7406 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
7407 enum machine_mode inner_mode = TYPE_MODE (inner_type);
7409 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7410 op0 = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, op0, inner_mode,
7411 subreg_lowpart_offset (mode,
7412 inner_mode));
7413 else
7414 op0= convert_modes (mode, inner_mode, op0,
7415 TYPE_UNSIGNED (inner_type));
7418 else if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7419 op0 = gen_rtx_fmt_e (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND, mode, op0);
7421 else if (target == 0)
7422 op0 = convert_to_mode (mode, op0,
7423 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
7424 (treeop0)));
7425 else
7427 convert_move (target, op0,
7428 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
7429 op0 = target;
7432 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
7434 case ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT_EXPR:
7436 tree treeop0_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
7437 addr_space_t as_to;
7438 addr_space_t as_from;
7440 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (type));
7441 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (treeop0_type));
7443 as_to = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (type));
7444 as_from = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0_type));
7446 /* Conversions between pointers to the same address space should
7447 have been implemented via CONVERT_EXPR / NOP_EXPR. */
7448 gcc_assert (as_to != as_from);
7450 /* Ask target code to handle conversion between pointers
7451 to overlapping address spaces. */
7452 if (targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_to, as_from)
7453 || targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_from, as_to))
7455 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
7456 op0 = targetm.addr_space.convert (op0, treeop0_type, type);
7457 gcc_assert (op0);
7458 return op0;
7461 /* For disjoint address spaces, converting anything but
7462 a null pointer invokes undefined behaviour. We simply
7463 always return a null pointer here. */
7464 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
7467 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
7468 /* Even though the sizetype mode and the pointer's mode can be different
7469 expand is able to handle this correctly and get the correct result out
7470 of the PLUS_EXPR code. */
7471 /* Make sure to sign-extend the sizetype offset in a POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
7472 if sizetype precision is smaller than pointer precision. */
7473 if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) < TYPE_PRECISION (type))
7474 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type,
7475 fold_convert_loc (loc, ssizetype,
7476 treeop1));
7477 case PLUS_EXPR:
7478 /* If we are adding a constant, a VAR_DECL that is sp, fp, or ap, and
7479 something else, make sure we add the register to the constant and
7480 then to the other thing. This case can occur during strength
7481 reduction and doing it this way will produce better code if the
7482 frame pointer or argument pointer is eliminated.
7484 fold-const.c will ensure that the constant is always in the inner
7485 PLUS_EXPR, so the only case we need to do anything about is if
7486 sp, ap, or fp is our second argument, in which case we must swap
7487 the innermost first argument and our second argument. */
7489 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == PLUS_EXPR
7490 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
7491 && TREE_CODE (treeop1) == VAR_DECL
7492 && (DECL_RTL (treeop1) == frame_pointer_rtx
7493 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == stack_pointer_rtx
7494 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == arg_pointer_rtx))
7496 tree t = treeop1;
7498 treeop1 = TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0);
7499 TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0) = t;
7502 /* If the result is to be ptr_mode and we are adding an integer to
7503 something, we might be forming a constant. So try to use
7504 plus_constant. If it produces a sum and we can't accept it,
7505 use force_operand. This allows P = &ARR[const] to generate
7506 efficient code on machines where a SYMBOL_REF is not a valid
7507 address.
7509 If this is an EXPAND_SUM call, always return the sum. */
7510 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7511 || (mode == ptr_mode && (unsignedp || ! flag_trapv)))
7513 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7514 target = 0;
7515 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST
7516 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7517 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop1))
7519 rtx constant_part;
7521 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, subtarget, VOIDmode,
7522 EXPAND_SUM);
7523 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
7524 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
7525 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
7526 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
7527 constant_part
7528 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop0),
7529 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
7530 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)));
7531 op1 = plus_constant (op1, INTVAL (constant_part));
7532 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7533 op1 = force_operand (op1, target);
7534 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op1);
7537 else if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
7538 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7539 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop0))
7541 rtx constant_part;
7543 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
7544 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7545 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_SUM));
7546 if (! CONSTANT_P (op0))
7548 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, NULL_RTX,
7549 VOIDmode, modifier);
7550 /* Return a PLUS if modifier says it's OK. */
7551 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM
7552 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7553 return simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1);
7554 goto binop2;
7556 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
7557 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
7558 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
7559 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
7560 constant_part
7561 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1),
7562 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
7563 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
7564 op0 = plus_constant (op0, INTVAL (constant_part));
7565 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7566 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
7567 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
7571 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
7572 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
7573 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
7574 zero-extend. */
7575 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7576 || mode != ptr_mode)
7578 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
7579 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7580 if (op0 == const0_rtx)
7581 return op1;
7582 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
7583 return op0;
7584 goto binop2;
7587 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
7588 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
7589 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
7591 case MINUS_EXPR:
7592 /* For initializers, we are allowed to return a MINUS of two
7593 symbolic constants. Here we handle all cases when both operands
7594 are constant. */
7595 /* Handle difference of two symbolic constants,
7596 for the sake of an initializer. */
7597 if ((modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7598 && really_constant_p (treeop0)
7599 && really_constant_p (treeop1))
7601 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
7602 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, modifier);
7604 /* If the last operand is a CONST_INT, use plus_constant of
7605 the negated constant. Else make the MINUS. */
7606 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
7607 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (plus_constant (op0, - INTVAL (op1)));
7608 else
7609 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, op0, op1));
7612 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
7613 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
7614 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
7615 zero-extend. */
7616 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7617 || mode != ptr_mode)
7618 goto binop;
7620 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
7621 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
7623 /* Convert A - const to A + (-const). */
7624 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
7626 op1 = negate_rtx (mode, op1);
7627 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
7630 goto binop2;
7632 case WIDEN_MULT_PLUS_EXPR:
7633 case WIDEN_MULT_MINUS_EXPR:
7634 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7635 op2 = expand_normal (ops->op2);
7636 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
7637 target, unsignedp);
7638 return target;
7640 case WIDEN_MULT_EXPR:
7641 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
7642 Thus the following special case checks need only
7643 check the second operand. */
7644 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
7646 tree t1 = treeop0;
7647 treeop0 = treeop1;
7648 treeop1 = t1;
7651 /* First, check if we have a multiplication of one signed and one
7652 unsigned operand. */
7653 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) != INTEGER_CST
7654 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
7655 != TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))))
7657 enum machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
7658 this_optab = usmul_widen_optab;
7659 if (mode == GET_MODE_2XWIDER_MODE (innermode))
7661 if (optab_handler (this_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7663 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
7664 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1,
7665 EXPAND_NORMAL);
7666 else
7667 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op1, &op0,
7668 EXPAND_NORMAL);
7669 goto binop3;
7673 /* Check for a multiplication with matching signedness. */
7674 else if ((TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
7675 && int_fits_type_p (treeop1, TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
7676 || (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))
7677 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))))
7679 tree op0type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
7680 enum machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (op0type);
7681 bool zextend_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (op0type);
7682 optab other_optab = zextend_p ? smul_widen_optab : umul_widen_optab;
7683 this_optab = zextend_p ? umul_widen_optab : smul_widen_optab;
7685 if (mode == GET_MODE_2XWIDER_MODE (innermode))
7687 if (optab_handler (this_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7689 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
7690 EXPAND_NORMAL);
7691 temp = expand_widening_mult (mode, op0, op1, target,
7692 unsignedp, this_optab);
7693 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
7695 if (optab_handler (other_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing
7696 && innermode == word_mode)
7698 rtx htem, hipart;
7699 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
7700 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST)
7701 op1 = convert_modes (innermode, mode,
7702 expand_normal (treeop1), unsignedp);
7703 else
7704 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
7705 temp = expand_binop (mode, other_optab, op0, op1, target,
7706 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7707 hipart = gen_highpart (innermode, temp);
7708 htem = expand_mult_highpart_adjust (innermode, hipart,
7709 op0, op1, hipart,
7710 zextend_p);
7711 if (htem != hipart)
7712 emit_move_insn (hipart, htem);
7713 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
7717 treeop0 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop0);
7718 treeop1 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop1);
7719 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7720 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
7722 case MULT_EXPR:
7723 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
7724 below because "expand_mult" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
7725 multiplications. */
7726 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
7727 goto binop;
7729 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
7730 Thus the following special case checks need only
7731 check the second operand. */
7732 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
7734 tree t1 = treeop0;
7735 treeop0 = treeop1;
7736 treeop1 = t1;
7739 /* Attempt to return something suitable for generating an
7740 indexed address, for machines that support that. */
7742 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM && mode == ptr_mode
7743 && host_integerp (treeop1, 0))
7745 tree exp1 = treeop1;
7747 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
7748 EXPAND_SUM);
7750 if (!REG_P (op0))
7751 op0 = force_operand (op0, NULL_RTX);
7752 if (!REG_P (op0))
7753 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op0);
7755 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MULT (mode, op0,
7756 gen_int_mode (tree_low_cst (exp1, 0),
7757 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp1)))));
7760 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7761 target = 0;
7763 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7764 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
7766 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
7767 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
7768 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
7769 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
7770 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
7771 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
7772 below because "expand_divmod" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
7773 divisions. */
7774 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
7775 goto binop;
7777 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7778 target = 0;
7779 /* Possible optimization: compute the dividend with EXPAND_SUM
7780 then if the divisor is constant can optimize the case
7781 where some terms of the dividend have coeffs divisible by it. */
7782 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
7783 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7784 return expand_divmod (0, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
7786 case RDIV_EXPR:
7787 goto binop;
7789 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
7790 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
7791 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
7792 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
7793 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7794 target = 0;
7795 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
7796 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7797 return expand_divmod (1, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
7799 case FIXED_CONVERT_EXPR:
7800 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
7801 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7802 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7804 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == INTEGER_TYPE
7805 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
7806 || (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)))
7807 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 1, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
7808 else
7809 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 0, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
7810 return target;
7812 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
7813 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
7814 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7815 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7816 expand_fix (target, op0, unsignedp);
7817 return target;
7819 case FLOAT_EXPR:
7820 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
7821 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7822 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7823 /* expand_float can't figure out what to do if FROM has VOIDmode.
7824 So give it the correct mode. With -O, cse will optimize this. */
7825 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
7826 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)),
7827 op0);
7828 expand_float (target, op0,
7829 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
7830 return target;
7832 case NEGATE_EXPR:
7833 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
7834 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7835 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7836 target = 0;
7837 temp = expand_unop (mode,
7838 optab_for_tree_code (NEGATE_EXPR, type,
7839 optab_default),
7840 op0, target, 0);
7841 gcc_assert (temp);
7842 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
7844 case ABS_EXPR:
7845 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
7846 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7847 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7848 target = 0;
7850 /* ABS_EXPR is not valid for complex arguments. */
7851 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
7852 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT);
7854 /* Unsigned abs is simply the operand. Testing here means we don't
7855 risk generating incorrect code below. */
7856 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
7857 return op0;
7859 return expand_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp,
7860 safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1));
7862 case MAX_EXPR:
7863 case MIN_EXPR:
7864 target = original_target;
7865 if (target == 0
7866 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
7867 || (MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
7868 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
7869 || (REG_P (target)
7870 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
7871 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7872 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
7873 target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7875 /* First try to do it with a special MIN or MAX instruction.
7876 If that does not win, use a conditional jump to select the proper
7877 value. */
7878 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
7879 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
7880 OPTAB_WIDEN);
7881 if (temp != 0)
7882 return temp;
7884 /* At this point, a MEM target is no longer useful; we will get better
7885 code without it. */
7887 if (! REG_P (target))
7888 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7890 /* If op1 was placed in target, swap op0 and op1. */
7891 if (target != op0 && target == op1)
7893 temp = op0;
7894 op0 = op1;
7895 op1 = temp;
7898 /* We generate better code and avoid problems with op1 mentioning
7899 target by forcing op1 into a pseudo if it isn't a constant. */
7900 if (! CONSTANT_P (op1))
7901 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
7904 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
7905 rtx cmpop1 = op1;
7907 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
7908 comparison_code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
7909 else
7910 comparison_code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
7912 /* Canonicalize to comparisons against 0. */
7913 if (op1 == const1_rtx)
7915 /* Converting (a >= 1 ? a : 1) into (a > 0 ? a : 1)
7916 or (a != 0 ? a : 1) for unsigned.
7917 For MIN we are safe converting (a <= 1 ? a : 1)
7918 into (a <= 0 ? a : 1) */
7919 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
7920 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
7921 comparison_code = unsignedp ? NE : GT;
7923 if (op1 == constm1_rtx && !unsignedp)
7925 /* Converting (a >= -1 ? a : -1) into (a >= 0 ? a : -1)
7926 and (a <= -1 ? a : -1) into (a < 0 ? a : -1) */
7927 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
7928 if (code == MIN_EXPR)
7929 comparison_code = LT;
7931 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
7932 /* Use a conditional move if possible. */
7933 if (can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
7935 rtx insn;
7937 /* ??? Same problem as in expmed.c: emit_conditional_move
7938 forces a stack adjustment via compare_from_rtx, and we
7939 lose the stack adjustment if the sequence we are about
7940 to create is discarded. */
7941 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
7943 start_sequence ();
7945 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
7946 insn = emit_conditional_move (target, comparison_code,
7947 op0, cmpop1, mode,
7948 op0, op1, mode,
7949 unsignedp);
7951 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
7952 and return. */
7953 if (insn)
7955 rtx seq = get_insns ();
7956 end_sequence ();
7957 emit_insn (seq);
7958 return target;
7961 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
7962 branches. */
7963 end_sequence ();
7965 #endif
7966 if (target != op0)
7967 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
7969 temp = gen_label_rtx ();
7970 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (target, cmpop1, comparison_code,
7971 unsignedp, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, temp,
7972 -1);
7974 emit_move_insn (target, op1);
7975 emit_label (temp);
7976 return target;
7978 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
7979 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
7980 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7981 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7982 target = 0;
7983 temp = expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, op0, target, 1);
7984 gcc_assert (temp);
7985 return temp;
7987 /* ??? Can optimize bitwise operations with one arg constant.
7988 Can optimize (a bitwise1 n) bitwise2 (a bitwise3 b)
7989 and (a bitwise1 b) bitwise2 b (etc)
7990 but that is probably not worth while. */
7992 /* BIT_AND_EXPR is for bitwise anding. TRUTH_AND_EXPR is for anding two
7993 boolean values when we want in all cases to compute both of them. In
7994 general it is fastest to do TRUTH_AND_EXPR by computing both operands
7995 as actual zero-or-1 values and then bitwise anding. In cases where
7996 there cannot be any side effects, better code would be made by
7997 treating TRUTH_AND_EXPR like TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR; but the question is
7998 how to recognize those cases. */
8000 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
8001 code = BIT_AND_EXPR;
8002 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
8003 goto binop;
8005 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
8006 code = BIT_IOR_EXPR;
8007 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
8008 goto binop;
8010 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
8011 code = BIT_XOR_EXPR;
8012 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
8013 goto binop;
8015 case LROTATE_EXPR:
8016 case RROTATE_EXPR:
8017 gcc_assert (VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type))
8018 || (GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (type))
8019 == TYPE_PRECISION (type)));
8020 /* fall through */
8022 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
8023 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
8024 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8025 below because "expand_shift" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8026 shifts. */
8027 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8028 goto binop;
8030 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, treeop1, 1))
8031 subtarget = 0;
8032 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8033 target = 0;
8034 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8035 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8036 temp = expand_shift (code, mode, op0, treeop1, target,
8037 unsignedp);
8038 if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR)
8039 temp = REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8040 return temp;
8042 /* Could determine the answer when only additive constants differ. Also,
8043 the addition of one can be handled by changing the condition. */
8044 case LT_EXPR:
8045 case LE_EXPR:
8046 case GT_EXPR:
8047 case GE_EXPR:
8048 case EQ_EXPR:
8049 case NE_EXPR:
8050 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
8051 case ORDERED_EXPR:
8052 case UNLT_EXPR:
8053 case UNLE_EXPR:
8054 case UNGT_EXPR:
8055 case UNGE_EXPR:
8056 case UNEQ_EXPR:
8057 case LTGT_EXPR:
8058 temp = do_store_flag (ops,
8059 modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? target : NULL_RTX,
8060 tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
8061 if (temp)
8062 return temp;
8064 /* Use a compare and a jump for BLKmode comparisons, or for function
8065 type comparisons is HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare. */
8067 if ((target == 0
8068 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8069 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1)
8070 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop1, 1)
8071 /* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
8072 value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
8073 || (!optimize && REG_P (target)
8074 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
8075 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
8077 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
8079 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
8080 jumpifnot_1 (code, treeop0, treeop1, op1, -1);
8082 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
8084 emit_label (op1);
8085 return target;
8087 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
8088 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8089 target = 0;
8090 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, target,
8091 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8092 /* The parser is careful to generate TRUTH_NOT_EXPR
8093 only with operands that are always zero or one. */
8094 temp = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, op0, const1_rtx,
8095 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8096 gcc_assert (temp);
8097 return temp;
8099 case COMPLEX_EXPR:
8100 /* Get the rtx code of the operands. */
8101 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8102 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8104 if (!target)
8105 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
8107 /* Move the real (op0) and imaginary (op1) parts to their location. */
8108 write_complex_part (target, op0, false);
8109 write_complex_part (target, op1, true);
8111 return target;
8113 case WIDEN_SUM_EXPR:
8115 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
8116 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
8118 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8119 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, op1,
8120 target, unsignedp);
8121 return target;
8124 case REDUC_MAX_EXPR:
8125 case REDUC_MIN_EXPR:
8126 case REDUC_PLUS_EXPR:
8128 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8129 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8130 temp = expand_unop (mode, this_optab, op0, target, unsignedp);
8131 gcc_assert (temp);
8132 return temp;
8135 case VEC_EXTRACT_EVEN_EXPR:
8136 case VEC_EXTRACT_ODD_EXPR:
8138 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8139 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8140 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8141 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
8142 OPTAB_WIDEN);
8143 gcc_assert (temp);
8144 return temp;
8147 case VEC_INTERLEAVE_HIGH_EXPR:
8148 case VEC_INTERLEAVE_LOW_EXPR:
8150 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8151 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8152 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8153 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
8154 OPTAB_WIDEN);
8155 gcc_assert (temp);
8156 return temp;
8159 case VEC_LSHIFT_EXPR:
8160 case VEC_RSHIFT_EXPR:
8162 target = expand_vec_shift_expr (ops, target);
8163 return target;
8166 case VEC_UNPACK_HI_EXPR:
8167 case VEC_UNPACK_LO_EXPR:
8169 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8170 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8171 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
8172 target, unsignedp);
8173 gcc_assert (temp);
8174 return temp;
8177 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_HI_EXPR:
8178 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_LO_EXPR:
8180 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8181 /* The signedness is determined from input operand. */
8182 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code,
8183 TREE_TYPE (treeop0),
8184 optab_default);
8185 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr
8186 (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
8187 target, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8189 gcc_assert (temp);
8190 return temp;
8193 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_HI_EXPR:
8194 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_LO_EXPR:
8196 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
8197 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
8199 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8200 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, NULL_RTX,
8201 target, unsignedp);
8202 gcc_assert (target);
8203 return target;
8206 case VEC_PACK_TRUNC_EXPR:
8207 case VEC_PACK_SAT_EXPR:
8208 case VEC_PACK_FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
8209 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8210 goto binop;
8212 default:
8213 gcc_unreachable ();
8216 /* Here to do an ordinary binary operator. */
8217 binop:
8218 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8219 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8220 binop2:
8221 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8222 binop3:
8223 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8224 target = 0;
8225 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
8226 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8227 gcc_assert (temp);
8228 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8230 #undef REDUCE_BIT_FIELD
8233 expand_expr_real_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
8234 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
8236 rtx op0, op1, temp, decl_rtl;
8237 tree type;
8238 int unsignedp;
8239 enum machine_mode mode;
8240 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
8241 optab this_optab;
8242 rtx subtarget, original_target;
8243 int ignore;
8244 tree context;
8245 bool reduce_bit_field;
8246 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
8247 struct separate_ops ops;
8248 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
8249 tree ssa_name = NULL_TREE;
8250 gimple g;
8252 type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
8253 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8254 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
8256 treeop0 = treeop1 = treeop2 = NULL_TREE;
8257 if (!VL_EXP_CLASS_P (exp))
8258 switch (TREE_CODE_LENGTH (code))
8260 default:
8261 case 3: treeop2 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
8262 case 2: treeop1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8263 case 1: treeop0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8264 case 0: break;
8266 ops.code = code;
8267 ops.type = type;
8268 ops.op0 = treeop0;
8269 ops.op1 = treeop1;
8270 ops.op2 = treeop2;
8271 ops.location = loc;
8273 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
8274 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
8275 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
8276 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
8278 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
8279 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
8280 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
8281 reduce_bit_field = (!ignore
8282 && TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE
8283 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type));
8285 /* If we are going to ignore this result, we need only do something
8286 if there is a side-effect somewhere in the expression. If there
8287 is, short-circuit the most common cases here. Note that we must
8288 not call expand_expr with anything but const0_rtx in case this
8289 is an initial expansion of a size that contains a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. */
8291 if (ignore)
8293 if (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp))
8294 return const0_rtx;
8296 /* Ensure we reference a volatile object even if value is ignored, but
8297 don't do this if all we are doing is taking its address. */
8298 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
8299 && TREE_CODE (exp) != FUNCTION_DECL
8300 && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
8301 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
8303 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
8304 if (MEM_P (temp))
8305 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
8306 return const0_rtx;
8309 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_unary
8310 || code == COMPONENT_REF || code == INDIRECT_REF)
8311 return expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
8312 modifier);
8314 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_binary
8315 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison
8316 || code == ARRAY_REF || code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
8318 expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
8319 expand_expr (treeop1, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
8320 return const0_rtx;
8322 else if (code == BIT_FIELD_REF)
8324 expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
8325 expand_expr (treeop1, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
8326 expand_expr (treeop2, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
8327 return const0_rtx;
8330 target = 0;
8333 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8334 target = 0;
8336 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
8337 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
8338 original_target = target;
8340 switch (code)
8342 case LABEL_DECL:
8344 tree function = decl_function_context (exp);
8346 temp = label_rtx (exp);
8347 temp = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, temp);
8349 if (function != current_function_decl
8350 && function != 0)
8351 LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (temp) = 1;
8353 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, temp);
8354 return temp;
8357 case SSA_NAME:
8358 /* ??? ivopts calls expander, without any preparation from
8359 out-of-ssa. So fake instructions as if this was an access to the
8360 base variable. This unnecessarily allocates a pseudo, see how we can
8361 reuse it, if partition base vars have it set already. */
8362 if (!currently_expanding_to_rtl)
8363 return expand_expr_real_1 (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp), target, tmode, modifier,
8364 NULL);
8366 g = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (exp);
8367 if (g)
8368 return expand_expr_real (gimple_assign_rhs_to_tree (g), target, tmode,
8369 modifier, NULL);
8371 ssa_name = exp;
8372 decl_rtl = get_rtx_for_ssa_name (ssa_name);
8373 exp = SSA_NAME_VAR (ssa_name);
8374 goto expand_decl_rtl;
8376 case PARM_DECL:
8377 case VAR_DECL:
8378 /* If a static var's type was incomplete when the decl was written,
8379 but the type is complete now, lay out the decl now. */
8380 if (DECL_SIZE (exp) == 0
8381 && COMPLETE_OR_UNBOUND_ARRAY_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
8382 && (TREE_STATIC (exp) || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)))
8383 layout_decl (exp, 0);
8385 /* TLS emulation hook - replace __thread vars with
8386 *__emutls_get_address (&_emutls.var). */
8387 if (! targetm.have_tls
8388 && TREE_CODE (exp) == VAR_DECL
8389 && DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (exp))
8391 exp = build_fold_indirect_ref_loc (loc, emutls_var_address (exp));
8392 return expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, NULL);
8395 /* ... fall through ... */
8397 case FUNCTION_DECL:
8398 case RESULT_DECL:
8399 decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (exp);
8400 expand_decl_rtl:
8401 gcc_assert (decl_rtl);
8402 decl_rtl = copy_rtx (decl_rtl);
8403 /* Record writes to register variables. */
8404 if (modifier == EXPAND_WRITE && REG_P (decl_rtl)
8405 && REGNO (decl_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8407 int i = REGNO (decl_rtl);
8408 int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[i][GET_MODE (decl_rtl)];
8409 while (nregs)
8411 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (crtl->asm_clobbers, i);
8412 i++;
8413 nregs--;
8417 /* Ensure variable marked as used even if it doesn't go through
8418 a parser. If it hasn't be used yet, write out an external
8419 definition. */
8420 if (! TREE_USED (exp))
8422 assemble_external (exp);
8423 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
8426 /* Show we haven't gotten RTL for this yet. */
8427 temp = 0;
8429 /* Variables inherited from containing functions should have
8430 been lowered by this point. */
8431 context = decl_function_context (exp);
8432 gcc_assert (!context
8433 || context == current_function_decl
8434 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
8435 /* ??? C++ creates functions that are not TREE_STATIC. */
8436 || TREE_CODE (exp) == FUNCTION_DECL);
8438 /* This is the case of an array whose size is to be determined
8439 from its initializer, while the initializer is still being parsed.
8440 See expand_decl. */
8442 if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && REG_P (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)))
8443 temp = validize_mem (decl_rtl);
8445 /* If DECL_RTL is memory, we are in the normal case and the
8446 address is not valid, get the address into a register. */
8448 else if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8450 if (alt_rtl)
8451 *alt_rtl = decl_rtl;
8452 decl_rtl = use_anchored_address (decl_rtl);
8453 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
8454 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
8455 && !memory_address_addr_space_p (DECL_MODE (exp),
8456 XEXP (decl_rtl, 0),
8457 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (decl_rtl)))
8458 temp = replace_equiv_address (decl_rtl,
8459 copy_rtx (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)));
8462 /* If we got something, return it. But first, set the alignment
8463 if the address is a register. */
8464 if (temp != 0)
8466 if (MEM_P (temp) && REG_P (XEXP (temp, 0)))
8467 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (temp, 0), DECL_ALIGN (exp));
8469 return temp;
8472 /* If the mode of DECL_RTL does not match that of the decl, it
8473 must be a promoted value. We return a SUBREG of the wanted mode,
8474 but mark it so that we know that it was already extended. */
8475 if (REG_P (decl_rtl) && GET_MODE (decl_rtl) != DECL_MODE (exp))
8477 enum machine_mode pmode;
8479 /* Get the signedness to be used for this variable. Ensure we get
8480 the same mode we got when the variable was declared. */
8481 if (code == SSA_NAME
8482 && (g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (ssa_name))
8483 && gimple_code (g) == GIMPLE_CALL)
8484 pmode = promote_function_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp,
8485 TREE_TYPE
8486 (TREE_TYPE (gimple_call_fn (g))),
8488 else
8489 pmode = promote_decl_mode (exp, &unsignedp);
8490 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == pmode);
8492 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, decl_rtl);
8493 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
8494 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
8495 return temp;
8498 return decl_rtl;
8500 case INTEGER_CST:
8501 temp = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp),
8502 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (exp), mode);
8504 return temp;
8506 case VECTOR_CST:
8508 tree tmp = NULL_TREE;
8509 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_INT
8510 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT
8511 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FRACT
8512 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_UFRACT
8513 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_ACCUM
8514 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_UACCUM)
8515 return const_vector_from_tree (exp);
8516 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
8518 tree type_for_mode = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, 1);
8519 if (type_for_mode)
8520 tmp = fold_unary_loc (loc, VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, type_for_mode, exp);
8522 if (!tmp)
8523 tmp = build_constructor_from_list (type,
8524 TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (exp));
8525 return expand_expr (tmp, ignore ? const0_rtx : target,
8526 tmode, modifier);
8529 case CONST_DECL:
8530 return expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, VOIDmode, modifier);
8532 case REAL_CST:
8533 /* If optimized, generate immediate CONST_DOUBLE
8534 which will be turned into memory by reload if necessary.
8536 We used to force a register so that loop.c could see it. But
8537 this does not allow gen_* patterns to perform optimizations with
8538 the constants. It also produces two insns in cases like "x = 1.0;".
8539 On most machines, floating-point constants are not permitted in
8540 many insns, so we'd end up copying it to a register in any case.
8542 Now, we do the copying in expand_binop, if appropriate. */
8543 return CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (exp),
8544 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8546 case FIXED_CST:
8547 return CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (exp),
8548 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8550 case COMPLEX_CST:
8551 /* Handle evaluating a complex constant in a CONCAT target. */
8552 if (original_target && GET_CODE (original_target) == CONCAT)
8554 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8555 rtx rtarg, itarg;
8557 rtarg = XEXP (original_target, 0);
8558 itarg = XEXP (original_target, 1);
8560 /* Move the real and imaginary parts separately. */
8561 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_REALPART (exp), rtarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8562 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_IMAGPART (exp), itarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8564 if (op0 != rtarg)
8565 emit_move_insn (rtarg, op0);
8566 if (op1 != itarg)
8567 emit_move_insn (itarg, op1);
8569 return original_target;
8572 /* ... fall through ... */
8574 case STRING_CST:
8575 temp = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
8577 /* temp contains a constant address.
8578 On RISC machines where a constant address isn't valid,
8579 make some insns to get that address into a register. */
8580 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
8581 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8582 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
8583 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (mode, XEXP (temp, 0),
8584 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (temp)))
8585 return replace_equiv_address (temp,
8586 copy_rtx (XEXP (temp, 0)));
8587 return temp;
8589 case SAVE_EXPR:
8591 tree val = treeop0;
8592 rtx ret = expand_expr_real_1 (val, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
8594 if (!SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp))
8596 /* We can indeed still hit this case, typically via builtin
8597 expanders calling save_expr immediately before expanding
8598 something. Assume this means that we only have to deal
8599 with non-BLKmode values. */
8600 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (ret) != BLKmode);
8602 val = build_decl (EXPR_LOCATION (exp),
8603 VAR_DECL, NULL, TREE_TYPE (exp));
8604 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (val) = 1;
8605 DECL_IGNORED_P (val) = 1;
8606 treeop0 = val;
8607 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = treeop0;
8608 SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp) = 1;
8610 if (!CONSTANT_P (ret))
8611 ret = copy_to_reg (ret);
8612 SET_DECL_RTL (val, ret);
8615 return ret;
8619 case CONSTRUCTOR:
8620 /* If we don't need the result, just ensure we evaluate any
8621 subexpressions. */
8622 if (ignore)
8624 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
8625 tree value;
8627 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
8628 expand_expr (value, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8630 return const0_rtx;
8633 return expand_constructor (exp, target, modifier, false);
8635 case MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF:
8636 case INDIRECT_REF:
8638 tree exp1 = treeop0;
8639 addr_space_t as = ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC;
8641 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE)
8643 tree t;
8645 t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
8646 if (t)
8647 return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
8650 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp1)))
8651 as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp1)));
8653 op0 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
8654 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
8656 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
8658 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
8659 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
8661 /* Resolve the misalignment now, so that we don't have to remember
8662 to resolve it later. Of course, this only works for reads. */
8663 if (code == MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF)
8665 int icode;
8666 rtx reg, insn;
8668 gcc_assert (modifier == EXPAND_NORMAL
8669 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM);
8671 /* The vectorizer should have already checked the mode. */
8672 icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode);
8673 gcc_assert (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing);
8675 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
8676 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail. */
8677 reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8679 /* Nor can the insn generator. */
8680 insn = GEN_FCN (icode) (reg, temp);
8681 emit_insn (insn);
8683 return reg;
8686 return temp;
8689 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
8691 addr_space_t as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
8692 struct mem_address addr;
8693 tree base;
8695 get_address_description (exp, &addr);
8696 op0 = addr_for_mem_ref (&addr, as, true);
8697 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
8698 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
8699 set_mem_attributes (temp, TMR_ORIGINAL (exp), 0);
8700 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
8701 base = get_base_address (TMR_ORIGINAL (exp));
8702 if (INDIRECT_REF_P (base)
8703 && TMR_BASE (exp)
8704 && TREE_CODE (TMR_BASE (exp)) == SSA_NAME
8705 && POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TMR_BASE (exp))))
8707 set_mem_expr (temp, build1 (INDIRECT_REF,
8708 TREE_TYPE (exp), TMR_BASE (exp)));
8709 set_mem_offset (temp, NULL_RTX);
8712 return temp;
8714 case MEM_REF:
8716 addr_space_t as
8717 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))));
8718 enum machine_mode address_mode;
8719 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8720 gimple def_stmt;
8721 /* Handle expansion of non-aliased memory with non-BLKmode. That
8722 might end up in a register. */
8723 if (TREE_CODE (base) == ADDR_EXPR)
8725 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = mem_ref_offset (exp).low;
8726 tree bit_offset;
8727 base = TREE_OPERAND (base, 0);
8728 if (!DECL_P (base))
8730 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
8731 base = get_addr_base_and_unit_offset (base, &off);
8732 gcc_assert (base);
8733 offset += off;
8735 /* If we are expanding a MEM_REF of a non-BLKmode non-addressable
8736 decl we must use bitfield operations. */
8737 if (DECL_P (base)
8738 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (base)
8739 && DECL_MODE (base) != BLKmode
8740 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (base)
8741 && !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (base)))
8743 tree bftype;
8744 if (offset == 0
8745 && host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), 1)
8746 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (base))
8747 == TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))))
8748 return expand_expr (build1 (VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR,
8749 TREE_TYPE (exp), base),
8750 target, tmode, modifier);
8751 bit_offset = bitsize_int (offset * BITS_PER_UNIT);
8752 bftype = TREE_TYPE (base);
8753 if (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != BLKmode)
8754 bftype = TREE_TYPE (exp);
8755 return expand_expr (build3 (BIT_FIELD_REF, bftype,
8756 base,
8757 TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
8758 bit_offset),
8759 target, tmode, modifier);
8762 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
8763 base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8764 if ((def_stmt = get_def_for_expr (base, BIT_AND_EXPR)))
8765 base = build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base),
8766 gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt),
8767 gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt));
8768 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
8769 base = build2 (POINTER_PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base),
8770 base, double_int_to_tree (sizetype,
8771 mem_ref_offset (exp)));
8772 op0 = expand_expr (base, NULL_RTX, address_mode, EXPAND_SUM);
8773 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
8774 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
8775 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
8776 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
8777 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
8778 MEM_VOLATILE_P (temp) = 1;
8779 return temp;
8782 case ARRAY_REF:
8785 tree array = treeop0;
8786 tree index = treeop1;
8788 /* Fold an expression like: "foo"[2].
8789 This is not done in fold so it won't happen inside &.
8790 Don't fold if this is for wide characters since it's too
8791 difficult to do correctly and this is a very rare case. */
8793 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
8794 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8795 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
8797 tree t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
8799 if (t)
8800 return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
8803 /* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
8804 just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
8805 we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
8806 that was declared const. */
8808 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
8809 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8810 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
8811 && TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR
8812 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
8813 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
8815 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
8816 tree field, value;
8818 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (array), ix,
8819 field, value)
8820 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
8822 if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
8823 return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode, modifier);
8824 break;
8828 else if (optimize >= 1
8829 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
8830 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8831 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
8832 && TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
8833 && TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (array)
8834 && TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != ERROR_MARK
8835 && targetm.binds_local_p (array))
8837 if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
8839 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (array);
8841 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
8843 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
8844 tree field, value;
8846 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), ix,
8847 field, value)
8848 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
8850 if (TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
8851 break;
8853 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
8855 /* If VALUE is a CONSTRUCTOR, this
8856 optimization is only useful if
8857 this doesn't store the CONSTRUCTOR
8858 into memory. If it does, it is more
8859 efficient to just load the data from
8860 the array directly. */
8861 rtx ret = expand_constructor (value, target,
8862 modifier, true);
8863 if (ret == NULL_RTX)
8864 break;
8867 return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode,
8868 modifier);
8871 else if(TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST)
8873 tree index1 = index;
8874 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
8875 index1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype,
8876 treeop1);
8878 /* Optimize the special-case of a zero lower bound.
8880 We convert the low_bound to sizetype to avoid some problems
8881 with constant folding. (E.g. suppose the lower bound is 1,
8882 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion,l (ARRAY
8883 +(INDEX-(unsigned char)1)) becomes ((ARRAY+(-(unsigned char)1))
8884 +INDEX), which becomes (ARRAY+255+INDEX). Opps!) */
8886 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
8887 index1 = size_diffop_loc (loc, index1,
8888 fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype,
8889 low_bound));
8891 if (0 > compare_tree_int (index1,
8892 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)))
8894 tree type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (init));
8895 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8897 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
8898 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1)
8899 return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)
8900 [TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index1)],
8901 mode);
8907 goto normal_inner_ref;
8909 case COMPONENT_REF:
8910 /* If the operand is a CONSTRUCTOR, we can just extract the
8911 appropriate field if it is present. */
8912 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == CONSTRUCTOR)
8914 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
8915 tree field, value;
8917 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (treeop0),
8918 idx, field, value)
8919 if (field == treeop1
8920 /* We can normally use the value of the field in the
8921 CONSTRUCTOR. However, if this is a bitfield in
8922 an integral mode that we can fit in a HOST_WIDE_INT,
8923 we must mask only the number of bits in the bitfield,
8924 since this is done implicitly by the constructor. If
8925 the bitfield does not meet either of those conditions,
8926 we can't do this optimization. */
8927 && (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
8928 || ((GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (field)) == MODE_INT)
8929 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (field))
8930 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))))
8932 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
8933 && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8934 target = 0;
8935 op0 = expand_expr (value, target, tmode, modifier);
8936 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
8938 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (field));
8939 enum machine_mode imode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (field));
8941 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (field)))
8943 op1 = GEN_INT (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1);
8944 op0 = expand_and (imode, op0, op1, target);
8946 else
8948 tree count
8949 = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
8950 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode) - bitsize);
8952 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
8953 target, 0);
8954 op0 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
8955 target, 0);
8959 return op0;
8962 goto normal_inner_ref;
8964 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
8965 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
8966 normal_inner_ref:
8968 enum machine_mode mode1, mode2;
8969 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
8970 tree offset;
8971 int volatilep = 0, must_force_mem;
8972 tree tem = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
8973 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
8974 rtx orig_op0, memloc;
8976 /* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
8977 we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
8978 infinitely recurse. */
8979 gcc_assert (tem != exp);
8981 /* If TEM's type is a union of variable size, pass TARGET to the inner
8982 computation, since it will need a temporary and TARGET is known
8983 to have to do. This occurs in unchecked conversion in Ada. */
8984 orig_op0 = op0
8985 = expand_expr (tem,
8986 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
8987 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
8988 != INTEGER_CST)
8989 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8990 ? target : NULL_RTX),
8991 VOIDmode,
8992 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8993 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
8994 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8995 ? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
8998 /* If the bitfield is volatile, we want to access it in the
8999 field's mode, not the computed mode. */
9000 if (volatilep
9001 && GET_CODE (op0) == MEM
9002 && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
9003 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, 0);
9005 mode2
9006 = CONSTANT_P (op0) ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) : GET_MODE (op0);
9008 /* If we have either an offset, a BLKmode result, or a reference
9009 outside the underlying object, we must force it to memory.
9010 Such a case can occur in Ada if we have unchecked conversion
9011 of an expression from a scalar type to an aggregate type or
9012 for an ARRAY_RANGE_REF whose type is BLKmode, or if we were
9013 passed a partially uninitialized object or a view-conversion
9014 to a larger size. */
9015 must_force_mem = (offset
9016 || mode1 == BLKmode
9017 || bitpos + bitsize > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode2));
9019 /* Handle CONCAT first. */
9020 if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT && !must_force_mem)
9022 if (bitpos == 0
9023 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
9024 return op0;
9025 if (bitpos == 0
9026 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9027 && bitsize)
9029 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
9030 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
9032 else if (bitpos == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9033 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 1)))
9034 && bitpos
9035 && bitsize)
9037 op0 = XEXP (op0, 1);
9038 bitpos = 0;
9039 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
9041 else
9042 /* Otherwise force into memory. */
9043 must_force_mem = 1;
9046 /* If this is a constant, put it in a register if it is a legitimate
9047 constant and we don't need a memory reference. */
9048 if (CONSTANT_P (op0)
9049 && mode2 != BLKmode
9050 && LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (op0)
9051 && !must_force_mem)
9052 op0 = force_reg (mode2, op0);
9054 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant, try to force it to the constant
9055 pool. Note that back-ends, e.g. MIPS, may refuse to do so if it
9056 is a legitimate constant. */
9057 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) && (memloc = force_const_mem (mode2, op0)))
9058 op0 = validize_mem (memloc);
9060 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant or the object is not in memory
9061 and need be, put it there. */
9062 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) || (!MEM_P (op0) && must_force_mem))
9064 tree nt = build_qualified_type (TREE_TYPE (tem),
9065 (TYPE_QUALS (TREE_TYPE (tem))
9066 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST));
9067 memloc = assign_temp (nt, 1, 1, 1);
9068 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
9069 op0 = memloc;
9072 if (offset)
9074 enum machine_mode address_mode;
9075 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
9076 EXPAND_SUM);
9078 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0));
9080 address_mode
9081 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (op0));
9082 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
9083 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
9085 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode
9086 /* A constant address in OP0 can have VOIDmode, we must
9087 not try to call force_reg in that case. */
9088 && GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) != VOIDmode
9089 && bitsize != 0
9090 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
9091 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
9092 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
9094 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9095 bitpos = 0;
9098 op0 = offset_address (op0, offset_rtx,
9099 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
9102 /* If OFFSET is making OP0 more aligned than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT,
9103 record its alignment as BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
9104 if (MEM_P (op0) && bitpos == 0 && offset != 0
9105 && is_aligning_offset (offset, tem))
9106 set_mem_align (op0, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
9108 /* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
9109 if (MEM_P (op0) && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
9111 if (op0 == orig_op0)
9112 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
9114 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
9117 /* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
9118 as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
9119 an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
9120 by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
9121 (which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
9122 storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode. */
9123 if (mode1 == VOIDmode
9124 || REG_P (op0) || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
9125 || (mode1 != BLKmode && ! direct_load[(int) mode1]
9126 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
9127 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
9128 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9129 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9130 /* If the field is volatile, we always want an aligned
9131 access. */
9132 || (volatilep && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
9133 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to fetch as a memref,
9134 fetch it as a bit field. */
9135 || (mode1 != BLKmode
9136 && (((TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem)) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
9137 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0)
9138 || (MEM_P (op0)
9139 && (MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)
9140 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1) != 0))))
9141 && ((modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9142 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9143 ? STRICT_ALIGNMENT
9144 : SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode1, MEM_ALIGN (op0))))
9145 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
9146 /* If the type and the field are a constant size and the
9147 size of the type isn't the same size as the bitfield,
9148 we must use bitfield operations. */
9149 || (bitsize >= 0
9150 && TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
9151 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
9152 && 0 != compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9153 bitsize)))
9155 enum machine_mode ext_mode = mode;
9157 if (ext_mode == BLKmode
9158 && ! (target != 0 && MEM_P (op0)
9159 && MEM_P (target)
9160 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0))
9161 ext_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
9163 if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
9165 if (target == 0)
9166 target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
9168 if (bitsize == 0)
9169 return target;
9171 /* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary and
9172 TARGET, if specified, must be a MEM. */
9173 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0)
9174 && (!target || MEM_P (target))
9175 && !(bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT));
9177 emit_block_move (target,
9178 adjust_address (op0, VOIDmode,
9179 bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT),
9180 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
9181 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
9182 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9183 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
9185 return target;
9188 op0 = validize_mem (op0);
9190 if (MEM_P (op0) && REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9191 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
9193 op0 = extract_bit_field (op0, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp,
9194 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9195 ? NULL_RTX : target),
9196 ext_mode, ext_mode);
9198 /* If the result is a record type and BITSIZE is narrower than
9199 the mode of OP0, an integral mode, and this is a big endian
9200 machine, we must put the field into the high-order bits. */
9201 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
9202 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
9203 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
9204 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
9205 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
9206 - bitsize),
9207 op0, 1);
9209 /* If the result type is BLKmode, store the data into a temporary
9210 of the appropriate type, but with the mode corresponding to the
9211 mode for the data we have (op0's mode). It's tempting to make
9212 this a constant type, since we know it's only being stored once,
9213 but that can cause problems if we are taking the address of this
9214 COMPONENT_REF because the MEM of any reference via that address
9215 will have flags corresponding to the type, which will not
9216 necessarily be constant. */
9217 if (mode == BLKmode)
9219 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (ext_mode);
9220 rtx new_rtx;
9222 /* If the reference doesn't use the alias set of its type,
9223 we cannot create the temporary using that type. */
9224 if (component_uses_parent_alias_set (exp))
9226 new_rtx = assign_stack_local (ext_mode, size, 0);
9227 set_mem_alias_set (new_rtx, get_alias_set (exp));
9229 else
9230 new_rtx = assign_stack_temp_for_type (ext_mode, size, 0, type);
9232 emit_move_insn (new_rtx, op0);
9233 op0 = copy_rtx (new_rtx);
9234 PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
9235 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 1);
9238 return op0;
9241 /* If the result is BLKmode, use that to access the object
9242 now as well. */
9243 if (mode == BLKmode)
9244 mode1 = BLKmode;
9246 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
9247 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9248 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9249 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9250 else
9251 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9253 if (op0 == orig_op0)
9254 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
9256 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 0);
9257 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9258 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
9260 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
9261 if (mode == mode1 || mode1 == BLKmode || mode1 == tmode
9262 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9263 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9264 return op0;
9265 else if (target == 0)
9266 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
9268 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
9269 return target;
9272 case OBJ_TYPE_REF:
9273 return expand_expr (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (exp), target, tmode, modifier);
9275 case CALL_EXPR:
9276 /* All valid uses of __builtin_va_arg_pack () are removed during
9277 inlining. */
9278 if (CALL_EXPR_VA_ARG_PACK (exp))
9279 error ("%Kinvalid use of %<__builtin_va_arg_pack ()%>", exp);
9281 tree fndecl = get_callee_fndecl (exp), attr;
9283 if (fndecl
9284 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("error",
9285 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
9286 error ("%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute error: %s",
9287 exp, identifier_to_locale (lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1)),
9288 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
9289 if (fndecl
9290 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("warning",
9291 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
9292 warning_at (tree_nonartificial_location (exp),
9293 0, "%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute warning: %s",
9294 exp, identifier_to_locale (lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1)),
9295 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
9297 /* Check for a built-in function. */
9298 if (fndecl && DECL_BUILT_IN (fndecl))
9300 gcc_assert (DECL_BUILT_IN_CLASS (fndecl) != BUILT_IN_FRONTEND);
9301 return expand_builtin (exp, target, subtarget, tmode, ignore);
9304 return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
9306 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9307 op0 = NULL_RTX;
9309 /* If we are converting to BLKmode, try to avoid an intermediate
9310 temporary by fetching an inner memory reference. */
9311 if (mode == BLKmode
9312 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
9313 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != BLKmode
9314 && handled_component_p (treeop0))
9316 enum machine_mode mode1;
9317 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
9318 tree offset;
9319 int unsignedp;
9320 int volatilep = 0;
9321 tree tem
9322 = get_inner_reference (treeop0, &bitsize, &bitpos,
9323 &offset, &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep,
9324 true);
9325 rtx orig_op0;
9327 /* ??? We should work harder and deal with non-zero offsets. */
9328 if (!offset
9329 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
9330 && bitsize >= 0
9331 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) == 0)
9333 /* See the normal_inner_ref case for the rationale. */
9334 orig_op0
9335 = expand_expr (tem,
9336 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
9337 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
9338 != INTEGER_CST)
9339 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9340 ? target : NULL_RTX),
9341 VOIDmode,
9342 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9343 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9344 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9345 ? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
9347 if (MEM_P (orig_op0))
9349 op0 = orig_op0;
9351 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
9352 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9353 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM
9354 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9355 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9356 else
9357 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9359 if (op0 == orig_op0)
9360 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
9362 set_mem_attributes (op0, treeop0, 0);
9363 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9364 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
9366 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
9371 if (!op0)
9372 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0,
9373 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
9375 /* If the input and output modes are both the same, we are done. */
9376 if (mode == GET_MODE (op0))
9378 /* If neither mode is BLKmode, and both modes are the same size
9379 then we can use gen_lowpart. */
9380 else if (mode != BLKmode && GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode
9381 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
9382 && !COMPLEX_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0)))
9384 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
9385 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
9386 op0 = gen_lowpart (mode, op0);
9388 /* If both types are integral, convert from one mode to the other. */
9389 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
9390 op0 = convert_modes (mode, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
9391 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
9392 /* As a last resort, spill op0 to memory, and reload it in a
9393 different mode. */
9394 else if (!MEM_P (op0))
9396 /* If the operand is not a MEM, force it into memory. Since we
9397 are going to be changing the mode of the MEM, don't call
9398 force_const_mem for constants because we don't allow pool
9399 constants to change mode. */
9400 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
9402 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
9404 if (target == 0 || GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (inner_type))
9405 target
9406 = assign_stack_temp_for_type
9407 (TYPE_MODE (inner_type),
9408 GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)), 0, inner_type);
9410 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
9411 op0 = target;
9414 /* At this point, OP0 is in the correct mode. If the output type is
9415 such that the operand is known to be aligned, indicate that it is.
9416 Otherwise, we need only be concerned about alignment for non-BLKmode
9417 results. */
9418 if (MEM_P (op0))
9420 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
9422 if (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (type))
9423 set_mem_align (op0, MAX (MEM_ALIGN (op0), TYPE_ALIGN (type)));
9424 else if (STRICT_ALIGNMENT
9425 && mode != BLKmode
9426 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
9428 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
9429 HOST_WIDE_INT temp_size
9430 = MAX (int_size_in_bytes (inner_type),
9431 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9432 rtx new_rtx
9433 = assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, temp_size, 0, type);
9434 rtx new_with_op0_mode
9435 = adjust_address (new_rtx, GET_MODE (op0), 0);
9437 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
9439 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode)
9440 emit_block_move (new_with_op0_mode, op0,
9441 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
9442 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9443 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
9444 else
9445 emit_move_insn (new_with_op0_mode, op0);
9447 op0 = new_rtx;
9450 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
9453 return op0;
9455 /* Use a compare and a jump for BLKmode comparisons, or for function
9456 type comparisons is HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare. */
9458 /* Although TRUTH_{AND,OR}IF_EXPR aren't present in GIMPLE, they
9459 are occassionally created by folding during expansion. */
9460 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9461 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9462 if (! ignore
9463 && (target == 0
9464 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9465 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1)
9466 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop1, 1)
9467 /* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
9468 value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
9469 || (!optimize && REG_P (target)
9470 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
9471 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
9473 if (target)
9474 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
9476 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
9477 jumpifnot_1 (code, treeop0, treeop1, op1, -1);
9479 if (target)
9480 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
9482 emit_label (op1);
9483 return ignore ? const0_rtx : target;
9485 case STATEMENT_LIST:
9487 tree_stmt_iterator iter;
9489 gcc_assert (ignore);
9491 for (iter = tsi_start (exp); !tsi_end_p (iter); tsi_next (&iter))
9492 expand_expr (tsi_stmt (iter), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9494 return const0_rtx;
9496 case COND_EXPR:
9497 /* A COND_EXPR with its type being VOID_TYPE represents a
9498 conditional jump and is handled in
9499 expand_gimple_cond_expr. */
9500 gcc_assert (!VOID_TYPE_P (type));
9502 /* Note that COND_EXPRs whose type is a structure or union
9503 are required to be constructed to contain assignments of
9504 a temporary variable, so that we can evaluate them here
9505 for side effect only. If type is void, we must do likewise. */
9507 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)
9508 && !ignore
9509 && TREE_TYPE (treeop1) != void_type_node
9510 && TREE_TYPE (treeop2) != void_type_node);
9512 /* If we are not to produce a result, we have no target. Otherwise,
9513 if a target was specified use it; it will not be used as an
9514 intermediate target unless it is safe. If no target, use a
9515 temporary. */
9517 if (modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9518 && original_target
9519 && safe_from_p (original_target, treeop0, 1)
9520 && GET_MODE (original_target) == mode
9521 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
9522 && (! can_conditionally_move_p (mode)
9523 || REG_P (original_target))
9524 #endif
9525 && !MEM_P (original_target))
9526 temp = original_target;
9527 else
9528 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 0, 1);
9530 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9531 NO_DEFER_POP;
9532 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
9533 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
9534 jumpifnot (treeop0, op0, -1);
9535 store_expr (treeop1, temp,
9536 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
9537 false);
9539 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (op1));
9540 emit_barrier ();
9541 emit_label (op0);
9542 store_expr (treeop2, temp,
9543 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
9544 false);
9546 emit_label (op1);
9547 OK_DEFER_POP;
9548 return temp;
9550 case VEC_COND_EXPR:
9551 target = expand_vec_cond_expr (type, treeop0, treeop1, treeop2, target);
9552 return target;
9554 case MODIFY_EXPR:
9556 tree lhs = treeop0;
9557 tree rhs = treeop1;
9558 gcc_assert (ignore);
9560 /* Check for |= or &= of a bitfield of size one into another bitfield
9561 of size 1. In this case, (unless we need the result of the
9562 assignment) we can do this more efficiently with a
9563 test followed by an assignment, if necessary.
9565 ??? At this point, we can't get a BIT_FIELD_REF here. But if
9566 things change so we do, this code should be enhanced to
9567 support it. */
9568 if (TREE_CODE (lhs) == COMPONENT_REF
9569 && (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
9570 || TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
9571 && TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0) == lhs
9572 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1)) == COMPONENT_REF
9573 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 1)))
9574 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), 1))))
9576 rtx label = gen_label_rtx ();
9577 int value = TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR;
9578 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1),
9579 value ? label : 0,
9580 value ? 0 : label, -1);
9581 expand_assignment (lhs, build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (rhs), value),
9582 MOVE_NONTEMPORAL (exp));
9583 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9584 emit_label (label);
9585 return const0_rtx;
9588 expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, MOVE_NONTEMPORAL (exp));
9589 return const0_rtx;
9592 case ADDR_EXPR:
9593 return expand_expr_addr_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
9595 case REALPART_EXPR:
9596 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9597 return read_complex_part (op0, false);
9599 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
9600 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9601 return read_complex_part (op0, true);
9603 case RETURN_EXPR:
9604 case LABEL_EXPR:
9605 case GOTO_EXPR:
9606 case SWITCH_EXPR:
9607 case ASM_EXPR:
9608 /* Expanded in cfgexpand.c. */
9609 gcc_unreachable ();
9611 case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
9612 case CATCH_EXPR:
9613 case EH_FILTER_EXPR:
9614 case TRY_FINALLY_EXPR:
9615 /* Lowered by tree-eh.c. */
9616 gcc_unreachable ();
9618 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
9619 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
9620 case TARGET_EXPR:
9621 case CASE_LABEL_EXPR:
9622 case VA_ARG_EXPR:
9623 case BIND_EXPR:
9624 case INIT_EXPR:
9625 case CONJ_EXPR:
9626 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9627 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
9628 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
9629 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
9630 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
9631 case LOOP_EXPR:
9632 case EXIT_EXPR:
9633 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
9634 gcc_unreachable ();
9636 case FDESC_EXPR:
9637 /* Function descriptors are not valid except for as
9638 initialization constants, and should not be expanded. */
9639 gcc_unreachable ();
9641 case WITH_SIZE_EXPR:
9642 /* WITH_SIZE_EXPR expands to its first argument. The caller should
9643 have pulled out the size to use in whatever context it needed. */
9644 return expand_expr_real (treeop0, original_target, tmode,
9645 modifier, alt_rtl);
9647 case REALIGN_LOAD_EXPR:
9649 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9650 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9651 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
9652 rtx op2;
9654 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
9655 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9656 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
9657 temp = expand_ternary_op (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, op2,
9658 target, unsignedp);
9659 gcc_assert (temp);
9660 return temp;
9663 case DOT_PROD_EXPR:
9665 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9666 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9667 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
9668 rtx op2;
9670 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9671 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
9672 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (&ops, op0, op1, op2,
9673 target, unsignedp);
9674 return target;
9677 case COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR:
9679 /* Initialize the anonymous variable declared in the compound
9680 literal, then return the variable. */
9681 tree decl = COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR_DECL (exp);
9683 /* Create RTL for this variable. */
9684 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl))
9686 if (DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl))
9687 /* The user specified an assembler name for this variable.
9688 Set that up now. */
9689 rest_of_decl_compilation (decl, 0, 0);
9690 else
9691 expand_decl (decl);
9694 return expand_expr_real (decl, original_target, tmode,
9695 modifier, alt_rtl);
9698 default:
9699 return expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, target, tmode, modifier);
9703 /* Subroutine of above: reduce EXP to the precision of TYPE (in the
9704 signedness of TYPE), possibly returning the result in TARGET. */
9705 static rtx
9706 reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx exp, rtx target, tree type)
9708 HOST_WIDE_INT prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
9709 if (target && GET_MODE (target) != GET_MODE (exp))
9710 target = 0;
9711 /* For constant values, reduce using build_int_cst_type. */
9712 if (CONST_INT_P (exp))
9714 HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (exp);
9715 tree t = build_int_cst_type (type, value);
9716 return expand_expr (t, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9718 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
9720 rtx mask = immed_double_int_const (double_int_mask (prec),
9721 GET_MODE (exp));
9722 return expand_and (GET_MODE (exp), exp, mask, target);
9724 else
9726 tree count = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
9727 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (exp)) - prec);
9728 exp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp), exp, count, target, 0);
9729 return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp), exp, count, target, 0);
9733 /* Subroutine of above: returns 1 if OFFSET corresponds to an offset that
9734 when applied to the address of EXP produces an address known to be
9735 aligned more than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
9737 static int
9738 is_aligning_offset (const_tree offset, const_tree exp)
9740 /* Strip off any conversions. */
9741 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
9742 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
9744 /* We must now have a BIT_AND_EXPR with a constant that is one less than
9745 power of 2 and which is larger than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
9746 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != BIT_AND_EXPR
9747 || !host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1)
9748 || compare_tree_int (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1),
9749 BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT) <= 0
9750 || !exact_log2 (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1) + 1) < 0)
9751 return 0;
9753 /* Look at the first operand of BIT_AND_EXPR and strip any conversion.
9754 It must be NEGATE_EXPR. Then strip any more conversions. */
9755 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
9756 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
9757 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
9759 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != NEGATE_EXPR)
9760 return 0;
9762 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
9763 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
9764 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
9766 /* This must now be the address of EXP. */
9767 return TREE_CODE (offset) == ADDR_EXPR && TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0) == exp;
9770 /* Return the tree node if an ARG corresponds to a string constant or zero
9771 if it doesn't. If we return nonzero, set *PTR_OFFSET to the offset
9772 in bytes within the string that ARG is accessing. The type of the
9773 offset will be `sizetype'. */
9775 tree
9776 string_constant (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset)
9778 tree array, offset, lower_bound;
9779 STRIP_NOPS (arg);
9781 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR)
9783 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == STRING_CST)
9785 *ptr_offset = size_zero_node;
9786 return TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
9788 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == VAR_DECL)
9790 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
9791 offset = size_zero_node;
9793 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == ARRAY_REF)
9795 array = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0);
9796 offset = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 1);
9797 if (TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST
9798 && TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL)
9799 return 0;
9801 /* Check if the array has a nonzero lower bound. */
9802 lower_bound = array_ref_low_bound (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0));
9803 if (!integer_zerop (lower_bound))
9805 /* If the offset and base aren't both constants, return 0. */
9806 if (TREE_CODE (lower_bound) != INTEGER_CST)
9807 return 0;
9808 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != INTEGER_CST)
9809 return 0;
9810 /* Adjust offset by the lower bound. */
9811 offset = size_diffop (fold_convert (sizetype, offset),
9812 fold_convert (sizetype, lower_bound));
9815 else
9816 return 0;
9818 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == PLUS_EXPR || TREE_CODE (arg) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
9820 tree arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
9821 tree arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
9823 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
9824 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
9826 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == ADDR_EXPR
9827 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == STRING_CST
9828 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
9830 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0);
9831 offset = arg1;
9833 else if (TREE_CODE (arg1) == ADDR_EXPR
9834 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == STRING_CST
9835 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
9837 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0);
9838 offset = arg0;
9840 else
9841 return 0;
9843 else
9844 return 0;
9846 if (TREE_CODE (array) == STRING_CST)
9848 *ptr_offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
9849 return array;
9851 else if (TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL)
9853 int length;
9855 /* Variables initialized to string literals can be handled too. */
9856 if (DECL_INITIAL (array) == NULL_TREE
9857 || TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != STRING_CST)
9858 return 0;
9860 /* If they are read-only, non-volatile and bind locally. */
9861 if (! TREE_READONLY (array)
9862 || TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
9863 || ! targetm.binds_local_p (array))
9864 return 0;
9866 /* Avoid const char foo[4] = "abcde"; */
9867 if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array) == NULL_TREE
9868 || TREE_CODE (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array)) != INTEGER_CST
9869 || (length = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (DECL_INITIAL (array))) <= 0
9870 || compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) < 0)
9871 return 0;
9873 /* If variable is bigger than the string literal, OFFSET must be constant
9874 and inside of the bounds of the string literal. */
9875 offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
9876 if (compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) > 0
9877 && (! host_integerp (offset, 1)
9878 || compare_tree_int (offset, length) >= 0))
9879 return 0;
9881 *ptr_offset = offset;
9882 return DECL_INITIAL (array);
9885 return 0;
9888 /* Generate code to calculate OPS, and exploded expression
9889 using a store-flag instruction and return an rtx for the result.
9890 OPS reflects a comparison.
9892 If TARGET is nonzero, store the result there if convenient.
9894 Return zero if there is no suitable set-flag instruction
9895 available on this machine.
9897 Once expand_expr has been called on the arguments of the comparison,
9898 we are committed to doing the store flag, since it is not safe to
9899 re-evaluate the expression. We emit the store-flag insn by calling
9900 emit_store_flag, but only expand the arguments if we have a reason
9901 to believe that emit_store_flag will be successful. If we think that
9902 it will, but it isn't, we have to simulate the store-flag with a
9903 set/jump/set sequence. */
9905 static rtx
9906 do_store_flag (sepops ops, rtx target, enum machine_mode mode)
9908 enum rtx_code code;
9909 tree arg0, arg1, type;
9910 tree tem;
9911 enum machine_mode operand_mode;
9912 int unsignedp;
9913 rtx op0, op1;
9914 rtx subtarget = target;
9915 location_t loc = ops->location;
9917 arg0 = ops->op0;
9918 arg1 = ops->op1;
9920 /* Don't crash if the comparison was erroneous. */
9921 if (arg0 == error_mark_node || arg1 == error_mark_node)
9922 return const0_rtx;
9924 type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
9925 operand_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9926 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
9928 /* We won't bother with BLKmode store-flag operations because it would mean
9929 passing a lot of information to emit_store_flag. */
9930 if (operand_mode == BLKmode)
9931 return 0;
9933 /* We won't bother with store-flag operations involving function pointers
9934 when function pointers must be canonicalized before comparisons. */
9935 #ifdef HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
9936 if (HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
9937 && ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg0)) == POINTER_TYPE
9938 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg0)))
9939 == FUNCTION_TYPE))
9940 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg1)) == POINTER_TYPE
9941 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg1)))
9942 == FUNCTION_TYPE))))
9943 return 0;
9944 #endif
9946 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
9947 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
9949 /* Get the rtx comparison code to use. We know that EXP is a comparison
9950 operation of some type. Some comparisons against 1 and -1 can be
9951 converted to comparisons with zero. Do so here so that the tests
9952 below will be aware that we have a comparison with zero. These
9953 tests will not catch constants in the first operand, but constants
9954 are rarely passed as the first operand. */
9956 switch (ops->code)
9958 case EQ_EXPR:
9959 code = EQ;
9960 break;
9961 case NE_EXPR:
9962 code = NE;
9963 break;
9964 case LT_EXPR:
9965 if (integer_onep (arg1))
9966 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
9967 else
9968 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
9969 break;
9970 case LE_EXPR:
9971 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
9972 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = LT;
9973 else
9974 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
9975 break;
9976 case GT_EXPR:
9977 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
9978 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = GE;
9979 else
9980 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
9981 break;
9982 case GE_EXPR:
9983 if (integer_onep (arg1))
9984 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
9985 else
9986 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
9987 break;
9989 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
9990 code = UNORDERED;
9991 break;
9992 case ORDERED_EXPR:
9993 code = ORDERED;
9994 break;
9995 case UNLT_EXPR:
9996 code = UNLT;
9997 break;
9998 case UNLE_EXPR:
9999 code = UNLE;
10000 break;
10001 case UNGT_EXPR:
10002 code = UNGT;
10003 break;
10004 case UNGE_EXPR:
10005 code = UNGE;
10006 break;
10007 case UNEQ_EXPR:
10008 code = UNEQ;
10009 break;
10010 case LTGT_EXPR:
10011 code = LTGT;
10012 break;
10014 default:
10015 gcc_unreachable ();
10018 /* Put a constant second. */
10019 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == REAL_CST || TREE_CODE (arg0) == INTEGER_CST
10020 || TREE_CODE (arg0) == FIXED_CST)
10022 tem = arg0; arg0 = arg1; arg1 = tem;
10023 code = swap_condition (code);
10026 /* If this is an equality or inequality test of a single bit, we can
10027 do this by shifting the bit being tested to the low-order bit and
10028 masking the result with the constant 1. If the condition was EQ,
10029 we xor it with 1. This does not require an scc insn and is faster
10030 than an scc insn even if we have it.
10032 The code to make this transformation was moved into fold_single_bit_test,
10033 so we just call into the folder and expand its result. */
10035 if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
10036 && TREE_CODE (arg0) == BIT_AND_EXPR && integer_zerop (arg1)
10037 && integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 1)))
10039 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
10040 return expand_expr (fold_single_bit_test (loc,
10041 code == NE ? NE_EXPR : EQ_EXPR,
10042 arg0, arg1, type),
10043 target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10046 if (! get_subtarget (target)
10047 || GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode)
10048 subtarget = 0;
10050 expand_operands (arg0, arg1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10052 if (target == 0)
10053 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10055 /* Try a cstore if possible. */
10056 return emit_store_flag_force (target, code, op0, op1,
10057 operand_mode, unsignedp, 1);
10061 /* Stubs in case we haven't got a casesi insn. */
10062 #ifndef HAVE_casesi
10063 # define HAVE_casesi 0
10064 # define gen_casesi(a, b, c, d, e) (0)
10065 # define CODE_FOR_casesi CODE_FOR_nothing
10066 #endif
10068 /* Attempt to generate a casesi instruction. Returns 1 if successful,
10069 0 otherwise (i.e. if there is no casesi instruction). */
10071 try_casesi (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
10072 rtx table_label ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx default_label,
10073 rtx fallback_label ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10075 enum machine_mode index_mode = SImode;
10076 int index_bits = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode);
10077 rtx op1, op2, index;
10078 enum machine_mode op_mode;
10080 if (! HAVE_casesi)
10081 return 0;
10083 /* Convert the index to SImode. */
10084 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (index_type)) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode))
10086 enum machine_mode omode = TYPE_MODE (index_type);
10087 rtx rangertx = expand_normal (range);
10089 /* We must handle the endpoints in the original mode. */
10090 index_expr = build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
10091 index_expr, minval);
10092 minval = integer_zero_node;
10093 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
10094 if (default_label)
10095 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (rangertx, index, LTU, NULL_RTX,
10096 omode, 1, default_label);
10097 /* Now we can safely truncate. */
10098 index = convert_to_mode (index_mode, index, 0);
10100 else
10102 if (TYPE_MODE (index_type) != index_mode)
10104 index_type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_size (index_bits, 0);
10105 index_expr = fold_convert (index_type, index_expr);
10108 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
10111 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10113 op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[0].mode;
10114 if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[0].predicate)
10115 (index, op_mode))
10116 index = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, index);
10118 op1 = expand_normal (minval);
10120 op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[1].mode;
10121 op1 = convert_modes (op_mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (minval)),
10122 op1, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (minval)));
10123 if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[1].predicate)
10124 (op1, op_mode))
10125 op1 = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, op1);
10127 op2 = expand_normal (range);
10129 op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[2].mode;
10130 op2 = convert_modes (op_mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
10131 op2, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range)));
10132 if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[2].predicate)
10133 (op2, op_mode))
10134 op2 = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, op2);
10136 emit_jump_insn (gen_casesi (index, op1, op2,
10137 table_label, !default_label
10138 ? fallback_label : default_label));
10139 return 1;
10142 /* Attempt to generate a tablejump instruction; same concept. */
10143 #ifndef HAVE_tablejump
10144 #define HAVE_tablejump 0
10145 #define gen_tablejump(x, y) (0)
10146 #endif
10148 /* Subroutine of the next function.
10150 INDEX is the value being switched on, with the lowest value
10151 in the table already subtracted.
10152 MODE is its expected mode (needed if INDEX is constant).
10153 RANGE is the length of the jump table.
10154 TABLE_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx for the table itself.
10156 DEFAULT_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx to jump to if the
10157 index value is out of range. */
10159 static void
10160 do_tablejump (rtx index, enum machine_mode mode, rtx range, rtx table_label,
10161 rtx default_label)
10163 rtx temp, vector;
10165 if (INTVAL (range) > cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents)
10166 cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents = INTVAL (range);
10168 /* Do an unsigned comparison (in the proper mode) between the index
10169 expression and the value which represents the length of the range.
10170 Since we just finished subtracting the lower bound of the range
10171 from the index expression, this comparison allows us to simultaneously
10172 check that the original index expression value is both greater than
10173 or equal to the minimum value of the range and less than or equal to
10174 the maximum value of the range. */
10176 if (default_label)
10177 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index, range, GTU, NULL_RTX, mode, 1,
10178 default_label);
10180 /* If index is in range, it must fit in Pmode.
10181 Convert to Pmode so we can index with it. */
10182 if (mode != Pmode)
10183 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 1);
10185 /* Don't let a MEM slip through, because then INDEX that comes
10186 out of PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS won't be a valid address,
10187 and break_out_memory_refs will go to work on it and mess it up. */
10188 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
10189 if (flag_pic && !REG_P (index))
10190 index = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, index);
10191 #endif
10193 /* ??? The only correct use of CASE_VECTOR_MODE is the one inside the
10194 GET_MODE_SIZE, because this indicates how large insns are. The other
10195 uses should all be Pmode, because they are addresses. This code
10196 could fail if addresses and insns are not the same size. */
10197 index = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
10198 gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, index,
10199 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (CASE_VECTOR_MODE))),
10200 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, table_label));
10201 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
10202 if (flag_pic)
10203 index = PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS (index);
10204 else
10205 #endif
10206 index = memory_address (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
10207 temp = gen_reg_rtx (CASE_VECTOR_MODE);
10208 vector = gen_const_mem (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
10209 convert_move (temp, vector, 0);
10211 emit_jump_insn (gen_tablejump (temp, table_label));
10213 /* If we are generating PIC code or if the table is PC-relative, the
10214 table and JUMP_INSN must be adjacent, so don't output a BARRIER. */
10215 if (! CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE && ! flag_pic)
10216 emit_barrier ();
10220 try_tablejump (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
10221 rtx table_label, rtx default_label)
10223 rtx index;
10225 if (! HAVE_tablejump)
10226 return 0;
10228 index_expr = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
10229 fold_convert (index_type, index_expr),
10230 fold_convert (index_type, minval));
10231 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
10232 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10234 do_tablejump (index, TYPE_MODE (index_type),
10235 convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (index_type),
10236 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
10237 expand_normal (range),
10238 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range))),
10239 table_label, default_label);
10240 return 1;
10243 /* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx for a VECTOR_CST tree. */
10244 static rtx
10245 const_vector_from_tree (tree exp)
10247 rtvec v;
10248 int units, i;
10249 tree link, elt;
10250 enum machine_mode inner, mode;
10252 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
10254 if (initializer_zerop (exp))
10255 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
10257 units = GET_MODE_NUNITS (mode);
10258 inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
10260 v = rtvec_alloc (units);
10262 link = TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (exp);
10263 for (i = 0; link; link = TREE_CHAIN (link), ++i)
10265 elt = TREE_VALUE (link);
10267 if (TREE_CODE (elt) == REAL_CST)
10268 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (elt),
10269 inner);
10270 else if (TREE_CODE (elt) == FIXED_CST)
10271 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (elt),
10272 inner);
10273 else
10274 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = immed_double_int_const (tree_to_double_int (elt),
10275 inner);
10278 /* Initialize remaining elements to 0. */
10279 for (; i < units; ++i)
10280 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST0_RTX (inner);
10282 return gen_rtx_CONST_VECTOR (mode, v);
10286 /* Build a decl for a EH personality function named NAME. */
10288 tree
10289 build_personality_function (const char *name)
10291 tree decl, type;
10293 type = build_function_type_list (integer_type_node, integer_type_node,
10294 long_long_unsigned_type_node,
10295 ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node, NULL_TREE);
10296 decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL,
10297 get_identifier (name), type);
10298 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = 1;
10299 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
10300 TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = 1;
10302 /* Zap the nonsensical SYMBOL_REF_DECL for this. What we're left with
10303 are the flags assigned by targetm.encode_section_info. */
10304 SET_SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), NULL);
10306 return decl;
10309 /* Extracts the personality function of DECL and returns the corresponding
10310 libfunc. */
10313 get_personality_function (tree decl)
10315 tree personality = DECL_FUNCTION_PERSONALITY (decl);
10316 enum eh_personality_kind pk;
10318 pk = function_needs_eh_personality (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
10319 if (pk == eh_personality_none)
10320 return NULL;
10322 if (!personality
10323 && pk == eh_personality_any)
10324 personality = lang_hooks.eh_personality ();
10326 if (pk == eh_personality_lang)
10327 gcc_assert (personality != NULL_TREE);
10329 return XEXP (DECL_RTL (personality), 0);
10332 #include "gt-expr.h"